PostgreSQL Source Code git master
Loading...
Searching...
No Matches
xlog.c
Go to the documentation of this file.
1/*-------------------------------------------------------------------------
2 *
3 * xlog.c
4 * PostgreSQL write-ahead log manager
5 *
6 * The Write-Ahead Log (WAL) functionality is split into several source
7 * files, in addition to this one:
8 *
9 * xloginsert.c - Functions for constructing WAL records
10 * xlogrecovery.c - WAL recovery and standby code
11 * xlogreader.c - Facility for reading WAL files and parsing WAL records
12 * xlogutils.c - Helper functions for WAL redo routines
13 *
14 * This file contains functions for coordinating database startup and
15 * checkpointing, and managing the write-ahead log buffers when the
16 * system is running.
17 *
18 * StartupXLOG() is the main entry point of the startup process. It
19 * coordinates database startup, performing WAL recovery, and the
20 * transition from WAL recovery into normal operations.
21 *
22 * XLogInsertRecord() inserts a WAL record into the WAL buffers. Most
23 * callers should not call this directly, but use the functions in
24 * xloginsert.c to construct the WAL record. XLogFlush() can be used
25 * to force the WAL to disk.
26 *
27 * In addition to those, there are many other functions for interrogating
28 * the current system state, and for starting/stopping backups.
29 *
30 *
31 * Portions Copyright (c) 1996-2026, PostgreSQL Global Development Group
32 * Portions Copyright (c) 1994, Regents of the University of California
33 *
34 * src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c
35 *
36 *-------------------------------------------------------------------------
37 */
38
39#include "postgres.h"
40
41#include <ctype.h>
42#include <math.h>
43#include <time.h>
44#include <fcntl.h>
45#include <sys/stat.h>
46#include <sys/time.h>
47#include <unistd.h>
48
49#include "access/clog.h"
50#include "access/commit_ts.h"
51#include "access/heaptoast.h"
52#include "access/multixact.h"
53#include "access/rewriteheap.h"
54#include "access/subtrans.h"
55#include "access/timeline.h"
56#include "access/transam.h"
57#include "access/twophase.h"
58#include "access/xact.h"
60#include "access/xlogarchive.h"
61#include "access/xloginsert.h"
62#include "access/xlogreader.h"
63#include "access/xlogrecovery.h"
64#include "access/xlogutils.h"
65#include "access/xlogwait.h"
66#include "backup/basebackup.h"
67#include "catalog/catversion.h"
68#include "catalog/pg_control.h"
69#include "catalog/pg_database.h"
71#include "common/file_utils.h"
72#include "executor/instrument.h"
73#include "miscadmin.h"
74#include "pg_trace.h"
75#include "pgstat.h"
76#include "port/atomics.h"
77#include "postmaster/bgwriter.h"
78#include "postmaster/startup.h"
81#include "replication/origin.h"
82#include "replication/slot.h"
87#include "storage/bufmgr.h"
88#include "storage/fd.h"
89#include "storage/ipc.h"
91#include "storage/latch.h"
92#include "storage/predicate.h"
93#include "storage/proc.h"
94#include "storage/procarray.h"
95#include "storage/reinit.h"
96#include "storage/spin.h"
97#include "storage/sync.h"
98#include "utils/guc_hooks.h"
99#include "utils/guc_tables.h"
102#include "utils/ps_status.h"
103#include "utils/relmapper.h"
104#include "utils/snapmgr.h"
105#include "utils/timeout.h"
106#include "utils/timestamp.h"
107#include "utils/varlena.h"
108
109#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
110#include "utils/memutils.h"
111#endif
112
113/* timeline ID to be used when bootstrapping */
114#define BootstrapTimeLineID 1
115
116/* User-settable parameters */
117int max_wal_size_mb = 1024; /* 1 GB */
118int min_wal_size_mb = 80; /* 80 MB */
120int XLOGbuffers = -1;
124bool EnableHotStandby = false;
125bool fullPageWrites = true;
126bool wal_log_hints = false;
130bool wal_init_zero = true;
131bool wal_recycle = true;
132bool log_checkpoints = true;
135int CommitDelay = 0; /* precommit delay in microseconds */
136int CommitSiblings = 5; /* # concurrent xacts needed to sleep */
139int wal_decode_buffer_size = 512 * 1024;
141
142#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
143bool XLOG_DEBUG = false;
144#endif
145
147
148/*
149 * Number of WAL insertion locks to use. A higher value allows more insertions
150 * to happen concurrently, but adds some CPU overhead to flushing the WAL,
151 * which needs to iterate all the locks.
152 */
153#define NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS 8
154
155/*
156 * Max distance from last checkpoint, before triggering a new xlog-based
157 * checkpoint.
158 */
160
161/* Estimated distance between checkpoints, in bytes */
163static double PrevCheckPointDistance = 0;
164
165/*
166 * Track whether there were any deferred checks for custom resource managers
167 * specified in wal_consistency_checking.
168 */
170
171/*
172 * GUC support
173 */
175 {"fsync", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC, false},
176#ifdef HAVE_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH
177 {"fsync_writethrough", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH, false},
178#endif
179 {"fdatasync", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FDATASYNC, false},
180#ifdef O_SYNC
181 {"open_sync", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN, false},
182#endif
183#ifdef O_DSYNC
184 {"open_datasync", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC, false},
185#endif
186 {NULL, 0, false}
187};
188
189
190/*
191 * Although only "on", "off", and "always" are documented,
192 * we accept all the likely variants of "on" and "off".
193 */
195 {"always", ARCHIVE_MODE_ALWAYS, false},
196 {"on", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, false},
197 {"off", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, false},
198 {"true", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, true},
199 {"false", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, true},
200 {"yes", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, true},
201 {"no", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, true},
202 {"1", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, true},
203 {"0", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, true},
204 {NULL, 0, false}
205};
206
207/*
208 * Statistics for current checkpoint are collected in this global struct.
209 * Because only the checkpointer or a stand-alone backend can perform
210 * checkpoints, this will be unused in normal backends.
211 */
213
214/*
215 * During recovery, lastFullPageWrites keeps track of full_page_writes that
216 * the replayed WAL records indicate. It's initialized with full_page_writes
217 * that the recovery starting checkpoint record indicates, and then updated
218 * each time XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record is replayed.
219 */
221
222/*
223 * Local copy of the state tracked by SharedRecoveryState in shared memory,
224 * It is false if SharedRecoveryState is RECOVERY_STATE_DONE. True actually
225 * means "not known, need to check the shared state".
226 */
227static bool LocalRecoveryInProgress = true;
228
229/*
230 * Local state for XLogInsertAllowed():
231 * 1: unconditionally allowed to insert XLOG
232 * 0: unconditionally not allowed to insert XLOG
233 * -1: must check RecoveryInProgress(); disallow until it is false
234 * Most processes start with -1 and transition to 1 after seeing that recovery
235 * is not in progress. But we can also force the value for special cases.
236 * The coding in XLogInsertAllowed() depends on the first two of these states
237 * being numerically the same as bool true and false.
238 */
240
241/*
242 * ProcLastRecPtr points to the start of the last XLOG record inserted by the
243 * current backend. It is updated for all inserts. XactLastRecEnd points to
244 * end+1 of the last record, and is reset when we end a top-level transaction,
245 * or start a new one; so it can be used to tell if the current transaction has
246 * created any XLOG records.
247 *
248 * While in parallel mode, this may not be fully up to date. When committing,
249 * a transaction can assume this covers all xlog records written either by the
250 * user backend or by any parallel worker which was present at any point during
251 * the transaction. But when aborting, or when still in parallel mode, other
252 * parallel backends may have written WAL records at later LSNs than the value
253 * stored here. The parallel leader advances its own copy, when necessary,
254 * in WaitForParallelWorkersToFinish.
255 */
259
260/*
261 * RedoRecPtr is this backend's local copy of the REDO record pointer
262 * (which is almost but not quite the same as a pointer to the most recent
263 * CHECKPOINT record). We update this from the shared-memory copy,
264 * XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr, whenever we can safely do so (ie, when we
265 * hold an insertion lock). See XLogInsertRecord for details. We are also
266 * allowed to update from XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr if we hold the info_lck;
267 * see GetRedoRecPtr.
268 *
269 * NB: Code that uses this variable must be prepared not only for the
270 * possibility that it may be arbitrarily out of date, but also for the
271 * possibility that it might be set to InvalidXLogRecPtr. We used to
272 * initialize it as a side effect of the first call to RecoveryInProgress(),
273 * which meant that most code that might use it could assume that it had a
274 * real if perhaps stale value. That's no longer the case.
275 */
277
278/*
279 * doPageWrites is this backend's local copy of (fullPageWrites ||
280 * runningBackups > 0). It is used together with RedoRecPtr to decide whether
281 * a full-page image of a page need to be taken.
282 *
283 * NB: Initially this is false, and there's no guarantee that it will be
284 * initialized to any other value before it is first used. Any code that
285 * makes use of it must recheck the value after obtaining a WALInsertLock,
286 * and respond appropriately if it turns out that the previous value wasn't
287 * accurate.
288 */
289static bool doPageWrites;
290
291/*----------
292 * Shared-memory data structures for XLOG control
293 *
294 * LogwrtRqst indicates a byte position that we need to write and/or fsync
295 * the log up to (all records before that point must be written or fsynced).
296 * The positions already written/fsynced are maintained in logWriteResult
297 * and logFlushResult using atomic access.
298 * In addition to the shared variable, each backend has a private copy of
299 * both in LogwrtResult, which is updated when convenient.
300 *
301 * The request bookkeeping is simpler: there is a shared XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst
302 * (protected by info_lck), but we don't need to cache any copies of it.
303 *
304 * info_lck is only held long enough to read/update the protected variables,
305 * so it's a plain spinlock. The other locks are held longer (potentially
306 * over I/O operations), so we use LWLocks for them. These locks are:
307 *
308 * WALBufMappingLock: must be held to replace a page in the WAL buffer cache.
309 * It is only held while initializing and changing the mapping. If the
310 * contents of the buffer being replaced haven't been written yet, the mapping
311 * lock is released while the write is done, and reacquired afterwards.
312 *
313 * WALWriteLock: must be held to write WAL buffers to disk (XLogWrite or
314 * XLogFlush).
315 *
316 * ControlFileLock: must be held to read/update control file or create
317 * new log file.
318 *
319 *----------
320 */
321
322typedef struct XLogwrtRqst
323{
324 XLogRecPtr Write; /* last byte + 1 to write out */
325 XLogRecPtr Flush; /* last byte + 1 to flush */
327
328typedef struct XLogwrtResult
329{
330 XLogRecPtr Write; /* last byte + 1 written out */
331 XLogRecPtr Flush; /* last byte + 1 flushed */
333
334/*
335 * Inserting to WAL is protected by a small fixed number of WAL insertion
336 * locks. To insert to the WAL, you must hold one of the locks - it doesn't
337 * matter which one. To lock out other concurrent insertions, you must hold
338 * of them. Each WAL insertion lock consists of a lightweight lock, plus an
339 * indicator of how far the insertion has progressed (insertingAt).
340 *
341 * The insertingAt values are read when a process wants to flush WAL from
342 * the in-memory buffers to disk, to check that all the insertions to the
343 * region the process is about to write out have finished. You could simply
344 * wait for all currently in-progress insertions to finish, but the
345 * insertingAt indicator allows you to ignore insertions to later in the WAL,
346 * so that you only wait for the insertions that are modifying the buffers
347 * you're about to write out.
348 *
349 * This isn't just an optimization. If all the WAL buffers are dirty, an
350 * inserter that's holding a WAL insert lock might need to evict an old WAL
351 * buffer, which requires flushing the WAL. If it's possible for an inserter
352 * to block on another inserter unnecessarily, deadlock can arise when two
353 * inserters holding a WAL insert lock wait for each other to finish their
354 * insertion.
355 *
356 * Small WAL records that don't cross a page boundary never update the value,
357 * the WAL record is just copied to the page and the lock is released. But
358 * to avoid the deadlock-scenario explained above, the indicator is always
359 * updated before sleeping while holding an insertion lock.
360 *
361 * lastImportantAt contains the LSN of the last important WAL record inserted
362 * using a given lock. This value is used to detect if there has been
363 * important WAL activity since the last time some action, like a checkpoint,
364 * was performed - allowing to not repeat the action if not. The LSN is
365 * updated for all insertions, unless the XLOG_MARK_UNIMPORTANT flag was
366 * set. lastImportantAt is never cleared, only overwritten by the LSN of newer
367 * records. Tracking the WAL activity directly in WALInsertLock has the
368 * advantage of not needing any additional locks to update the value.
369 */
376
377/*
378 * All the WAL insertion locks are allocated as an array in shared memory. We
379 * force the array stride to be a power of 2, which saves a few cycles in
380 * indexing, but more importantly also ensures that individual slots don't
381 * cross cache line boundaries. (Of course, we have to also ensure that the
382 * array start address is suitably aligned.)
383 */
389
390/*
391 * Session status of running backup, used for sanity checks in SQL-callable
392 * functions to start and stop backups.
393 */
395
396/*
397 * Shared state data for WAL insertion.
398 */
399typedef struct XLogCtlInsert
400{
401 slock_t insertpos_lck; /* protects CurrBytePos and PrevBytePos */
402
403 /*
404 * CurrBytePos is the end of reserved WAL. The next record will be
405 * inserted at that position. PrevBytePos is the start position of the
406 * previously inserted (or rather, reserved) record - it is copied to the
407 * prev-link of the next record. These are stored as "usable byte
408 * positions" rather than XLogRecPtrs (see XLogBytePosToRecPtr()).
409 */
412
413 /*
414 * Make sure the above heavily-contended spinlock and byte positions are
415 * on their own cache line. In particular, the RedoRecPtr and full page
416 * write variables below should be on a different cache line. They are
417 * read on every WAL insertion, but updated rarely, and we don't want
418 * those reads to steal the cache line containing Curr/PrevBytePos.
419 */
421
422 /*
423 * fullPageWrites is the authoritative value used by all backends to
424 * determine whether to write full-page image to WAL. This shared value,
425 * instead of the process-local fullPageWrites, is required because, when
426 * full_page_writes is changed by SIGHUP, we must WAL-log it before it
427 * actually affects WAL-logging by backends. Checkpointer sets at startup
428 * or after SIGHUP.
429 *
430 * To read these fields, you must hold an insertion lock. To modify them,
431 * you must hold ALL the locks.
432 */
433 XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr; /* current redo point for insertions */
435
436 /*
437 * runningBackups is a counter indicating the number of backups currently
438 * in progress. lastBackupStart is the latest checkpoint redo location
439 * used as a starting point for an online backup.
440 */
443
444 /*
445 * WAL insertion locks.
446 */
449
450/*
451 * Total shared-memory state for XLOG.
452 */
453typedef struct XLogCtlData
454{
456
457 /* Protected by info_lck: */
459 XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr; /* a recent copy of Insert->RedoRecPtr */
460 XLogRecPtr asyncXactLSN; /* LSN of newest async commit/abort */
461 XLogRecPtr replicationSlotMinLSN; /* oldest LSN needed by any slot */
462
463 XLogSegNo lastRemovedSegNo; /* latest removed/recycled XLOG segment */
464
465 /* Fake LSN counter, for unlogged relations. */
467
468 /* Time and LSN of last xlog segment switch. Protected by WALWriteLock. */
471
472 /* These are accessed using atomics -- info_lck not needed */
473 pg_atomic_uint64 logInsertResult; /* last byte + 1 inserted to buffers */
474 pg_atomic_uint64 logWriteResult; /* last byte + 1 written out */
475 pg_atomic_uint64 logFlushResult; /* last byte + 1 flushed */
476
477 /*
478 * Latest initialized page in the cache (last byte position + 1).
479 *
480 * To change the identity of a buffer (and InitializedUpTo), you need to
481 * hold WALBufMappingLock. To change the identity of a buffer that's
482 * still dirty, the old page needs to be written out first, and for that
483 * you need WALWriteLock, and you need to ensure that there are no
484 * in-progress insertions to the page by calling
485 * WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish().
486 */
488
489 /*
490 * These values do not change after startup, although the pointed-to pages
491 * and xlblocks values certainly do. xlblocks values are protected by
492 * WALBufMappingLock.
493 */
494 char *pages; /* buffers for unwritten XLOG pages */
495 pg_atomic_uint64 *xlblocks; /* 1st byte ptr-s + XLOG_BLCKSZ */
496 int XLogCacheBlck; /* highest allocated xlog buffer index */
497
498 /*
499 * InsertTimeLineID is the timeline into which new WAL is being inserted
500 * and flushed. It is zero during recovery, and does not change once set.
501 *
502 * If we create a new timeline when the system was started up,
503 * PrevTimeLineID is the old timeline's ID that we forked off from.
504 * Otherwise it's equal to InsertTimeLineID.
505 *
506 * We set these fields while holding info_lck. Most that reads these
507 * values knows that recovery is no longer in progress and so can safely
508 * read the value without a lock, but code that could be run either during
509 * or after recovery can take info_lck while reading these values.
510 */
513
514 /*
515 * SharedRecoveryState indicates if we're still in crash or archive
516 * recovery. Protected by info_lck.
517 */
519
520 /*
521 * InstallXLogFileSegmentActive indicates whether the checkpointer should
522 * arrange for future segments by recycling and/or PreallocXlogFiles().
523 * Protected by ControlFileLock. Only the startup process changes it. If
524 * true, anyone can use InstallXLogFileSegment(). If false, the startup
525 * process owns the exclusive right to install segments, by reading from
526 * the archive and possibly replacing existing files.
527 */
529
530 /*
531 * WalWriterSleeping indicates whether the WAL writer is currently in
532 * low-power mode (and hence should be nudged if an async commit occurs).
533 * Protected by info_lck.
534 */
536
537 /*
538 * During recovery, we keep a copy of the latest checkpoint record here.
539 * lastCheckPointRecPtr points to start of checkpoint record and
540 * lastCheckPointEndPtr points to end+1 of checkpoint record. Used by the
541 * checkpointer when it wants to create a restartpoint.
542 *
543 * Protected by info_lck.
544 */
548
549 /*
550 * lastFpwDisableRecPtr points to the start of the last replayed
551 * XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record that instructs full_page_writes is disabled.
552 */
554
555 slock_t info_lck; /* locks shared variables shown above */
557
558/*
559 * Classification of XLogInsertRecord operations.
560 */
567
569
570/* a private copy of XLogCtl->Insert.WALInsertLocks, for convenience */
572
573/*
574 * We maintain an image of pg_control in shared memory.
575 */
577
578/*
579 * Calculate the amount of space left on the page after 'endptr'. Beware
580 * multiple evaluation!
581 */
582#define INSERT_FREESPACE(endptr) \
583 (((endptr) % XLOG_BLCKSZ == 0) ? 0 : (XLOG_BLCKSZ - (endptr) % XLOG_BLCKSZ))
584
585/* Macro to advance to next buffer index. */
586#define NextBufIdx(idx) \
587 (((idx) == XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck) ? 0 : ((idx) + 1))
588
589/*
590 * XLogRecPtrToBufIdx returns the index of the WAL buffer that holds, or
591 * would hold if it was in cache, the page containing 'recptr'.
592 */
593#define XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(recptr) \
594 (((recptr) / XLOG_BLCKSZ) % (XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck + 1))
595
596/*
597 * These are the number of bytes in a WAL page usable for WAL data.
598 */
599#define UsableBytesInPage (XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogShortPHD)
600
601/*
602 * Convert values of GUCs measured in megabytes to equiv. segment count.
603 * Rounds down.
604 */
605#define ConvertToXSegs(x, segsize) XLogMBVarToSegs((x), (segsize))
606
607/* The number of bytes in a WAL segment usable for WAL data. */
609
610/*
611 * Private, possibly out-of-date copy of shared LogwrtResult.
612 * See discussion above.
613 */
615
616/*
617 * Update local copy of shared XLogCtl->log{Write,Flush}Result
618 *
619 * It's critical that Flush always trails Write, so the order of the reads is
620 * important, as is the barrier. See also XLogWrite.
621 */
622#define RefreshXLogWriteResult(_target) \
623 do { \
624 _target.Flush = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->logFlushResult); \
625 pg_read_barrier(); \
626 _target.Write = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->logWriteResult); \
627 } while (0)
628
629/*
630 * openLogFile is -1 or a kernel FD for an open log file segment.
631 * openLogSegNo identifies the segment, and openLogTLI the corresponding TLI.
632 * These variables are only used to write the XLOG, and so will normally refer
633 * to the active segment.
634 *
635 * Note: call Reserve/ReleaseExternalFD to track consumption of this FD.
636 */
637static int openLogFile = -1;
640
641/*
642 * Local copies of equivalent fields in the control file. When running
643 * crash recovery, LocalMinRecoveryPoint is set to InvalidXLogRecPtr as we
644 * expect to replay all the WAL available, and updateMinRecoveryPoint is
645 * switched to false to prevent any updates while replaying records.
646 * Those values are kept consistent as long as crash recovery runs.
647 */
650static bool updateMinRecoveryPoint = true;
651
652/* For WALInsertLockAcquire/Release functions */
653static int MyLockNo = 0;
654static bool holdingAllLocks = false;
655
656#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
658#endif
659
663static void CheckRequiredParameterValues(void);
664static void XLogReportParameters(void);
665static int LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed(void);
666static void CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord(void);
670static void CheckPointGuts(XLogRecPtr checkPointRedo, int flags);
673
675 bool opportunistic);
676static void XLogWrite(XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst, TimeLineID tli, bool flexible);
677static bool InstallXLogFileSegment(XLogSegNo *segno, char *tmppath,
679 TimeLineID tli);
680static void XLogFileClose(void);
681static void PreallocXlogFiles(XLogRecPtr endptr, TimeLineID tli);
682static void RemoveTempXlogFiles(void);
685static void RemoveXlogFile(const struct dirent *segment_de,
688static void UpdateLastRemovedPtr(char *filename);
689static void ValidateXLOGDirectoryStructure(void);
690static void CleanupBackupHistory(void);
691static void UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(XLogRecPtr lsn, bool force);
692static bool PerformRecoveryXLogAction(void);
693static void InitControlFile(uint64 sysidentifier, uint32 data_checksum_version);
694static void WriteControlFile(void);
695static void ReadControlFile(void);
696static void UpdateControlFile(void);
697static char *str_time(pg_time_t tnow, char *buf, size_t bufsize);
698
699static int get_sync_bit(int method);
700
701static void CopyXLogRecordToWAL(int write_len, bool isLogSwitch,
704 TimeLineID tli);
705static void ReserveXLogInsertLocation(int size, XLogRecPtr *StartPos,
710static char *GetXLogBuffer(XLogRecPtr ptr, TimeLineID tli);
714
715static void WALInsertLockAcquire(void);
716static void WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(void);
717static void WALInsertLockRelease(void);
718static void WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(XLogRecPtr insertingAt);
719
720/*
721 * Insert an XLOG record represented by an already-constructed chain of data
722 * chunks. This is a low-level routine; to construct the WAL record header
723 * and data, use the higher-level routines in xloginsert.c.
724 *
725 * If 'fpw_lsn' is valid, it is the oldest LSN among the pages that this
726 * WAL record applies to, that were not included in the record as full page
727 * images. If fpw_lsn <= RedoRecPtr, the function does not perform the
728 * insertion and returns InvalidXLogRecPtr. The caller can then recalculate
729 * which pages need a full-page image, and retry. If fpw_lsn is invalid, the
730 * record is always inserted.
731 *
732 * 'flags' gives more in-depth control on the record being inserted. See
733 * XLogSetRecordFlags() for details.
734 *
735 * 'topxid_included' tells whether the top-transaction id is logged along with
736 * current subtransaction. See XLogRecordAssemble().
737 *
738 * The first XLogRecData in the chain must be for the record header, and its
739 * data must be MAXALIGNed. XLogInsertRecord fills in the xl_prev and
740 * xl_crc fields in the header, the rest of the header must already be filled
741 * by the caller.
742 *
743 * Returns XLOG pointer to end of record (beginning of next record).
744 * This can be used as LSN for data pages affected by the logged action.
745 * (LSN is the XLOG point up to which the XLOG must be flushed to disk
746 * before the data page can be written out. This implements the basic
747 * WAL rule "write the log before the data".)
748 */
752 uint8 flags,
753 int num_fpi,
755 bool topxid_included)
756{
759 bool inserted;
760 XLogRecord *rechdr = (XLogRecord *) rdata->data;
761 uint8 info = rechdr->xl_info & ~XLR_INFO_MASK;
767
768 /* Does this record type require special handling? */
769 if (unlikely(rechdr->xl_rmid == RM_XLOG_ID))
770 {
771 if (info == XLOG_SWITCH)
773 else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO)
775 }
776
777 /* we assume that all of the record header is in the first chunk */
779
780 /* cross-check on whether we should be here or not */
781 if (!XLogInsertAllowed())
782 elog(ERROR, "cannot make new WAL entries during recovery");
783
784 /*
785 * Given that we're not in recovery, InsertTimeLineID is set and can't
786 * change, so we can read it without a lock.
787 */
789
790 /*----------
791 *
792 * We have now done all the preparatory work we can without holding a
793 * lock or modifying shared state. From here on, inserting the new WAL
794 * record to the shared WAL buffer cache is a two-step process:
795 *
796 * 1. Reserve the right amount of space from the WAL. The current head of
797 * reserved space is kept in Insert->CurrBytePos, and is protected by
798 * insertpos_lck.
799 *
800 * 2. Copy the record to the reserved WAL space. This involves finding the
801 * correct WAL buffer containing the reserved space, and copying the
802 * record in place. This can be done concurrently in multiple processes.
803 *
804 * To keep track of which insertions are still in-progress, each concurrent
805 * inserter acquires an insertion lock. In addition to just indicating that
806 * an insertion is in progress, the lock tells others how far the inserter
807 * has progressed. There is a small fixed number of insertion locks,
808 * determined by NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS. When an inserter crosses a page
809 * boundary, it updates the value stored in the lock to the how far it has
810 * inserted, to allow the previous buffer to be flushed.
811 *
812 * Holding onto an insertion lock also protects RedoRecPtr and
813 * fullPageWrites from changing until the insertion is finished.
814 *
815 * Step 2 can usually be done completely in parallel. If the required WAL
816 * page is not initialized yet, you have to grab WALBufMappingLock to
817 * initialize it, but the WAL writer tries to do that ahead of insertions
818 * to avoid that from happening in the critical path.
819 *
820 *----------
821 */
823
824 if (likely(class == WALINSERT_NORMAL))
825 {
827
828 /*
829 * Check to see if my copy of RedoRecPtr is out of date. If so, may
830 * have to go back and have the caller recompute everything. This can
831 * only happen just after a checkpoint, so it's better to be slow in
832 * this case and fast otherwise.
833 *
834 * Also check to see if fullPageWrites was just turned on or there's a
835 * running backup (which forces full-page writes); if we weren't
836 * already doing full-page writes then go back and recompute.
837 *
838 * If we aren't doing full-page writes then RedoRecPtr doesn't
839 * actually affect the contents of the XLOG record, so we'll update
840 * our local copy but not force a recomputation. (If doPageWrites was
841 * just turned off, we could recompute the record without full pages,
842 * but we choose not to bother.)
843 */
844 if (RedoRecPtr != Insert->RedoRecPtr)
845 {
847 RedoRecPtr = Insert->RedoRecPtr;
848 }
849 doPageWrites = (Insert->fullPageWrites || Insert->runningBackups > 0);
850
851 if (doPageWrites &&
854 {
855 /*
856 * Oops, some buffer now needs to be backed up that the caller
857 * didn't back up. Start over.
858 */
861 return InvalidXLogRecPtr;
862 }
863
864 /*
865 * Reserve space for the record in the WAL. This also sets the xl_prev
866 * pointer.
867 */
869 &rechdr->xl_prev);
870
871 /* Normal records are always inserted. */
872 inserted = true;
873 }
874 else if (class == WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH)
875 {
876 /*
877 * In order to insert an XLOG_SWITCH record, we need to hold all of
878 * the WAL insertion locks, not just one, so that no one else can
879 * begin inserting a record until we've figured out how much space
880 * remains in the current WAL segment and claimed all of it.
881 *
882 * Nonetheless, this case is simpler than the normal cases handled
883 * below, which must check for changes in doPageWrites and RedoRecPtr.
884 * Those checks are only needed for records that can contain buffer
885 * references, and an XLOG_SWITCH record never does.
886 */
890 }
891 else
892 {
894
895 /*
896 * We need to update both the local and shared copies of RedoRecPtr,
897 * which means that we need to hold all the WAL insertion locks.
898 * However, there can't be any buffer references, so as above, we need
899 * not check RedoRecPtr before inserting the record; we just need to
900 * update it afterwards.
901 */
905 &rechdr->xl_prev);
906 RedoRecPtr = Insert->RedoRecPtr = StartPos;
907 inserted = true;
908 }
909
910 if (inserted)
911 {
912 /*
913 * Now that xl_prev has been filled in, calculate CRC of the record
914 * header.
915 */
916 rdata_crc = rechdr->xl_crc;
919 rechdr->xl_crc = rdata_crc;
920
921 /*
922 * All the record data, including the header, is now ready to be
923 * inserted. Copy the record in the space reserved.
924 */
925 CopyXLogRecordToWAL(rechdr->xl_tot_len,
928
929 /*
930 * Unless record is flagged as not important, update LSN of last
931 * important record in the current slot. When holding all locks, just
932 * update the first one.
933 */
934 if ((flags & XLOG_MARK_UNIMPORTANT) == 0)
935 {
936 int lockno = holdingAllLocks ? 0 : MyLockNo;
937
939 }
940 }
941 else
942 {
943 /*
944 * This was an xlog-switch record, but the current insert location was
945 * already exactly at the beginning of a segment, so there was no need
946 * to do anything.
947 */
948 }
949
950 /*
951 * Done! Let others know that we're finished.
952 */
954
956
958
959 /*
960 * Mark top transaction id is logged (if needed) so that we should not try
961 * to log it again with the next WAL record in the current subtransaction.
962 */
963 if (topxid_included)
965
966 /*
967 * Update shared LogwrtRqst.Write, if we crossed page boundary.
968 */
970 {
972 /* advance global request to include new block(s) */
977 }
978
979 /*
980 * If this was an XLOG_SWITCH record, flush the record and the empty
981 * padding space that fills the rest of the segment, and perform
982 * end-of-segment actions (eg, notifying archiver).
983 */
984 if (class == WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH)
985 {
988
989 /*
990 * Even though we reserved the rest of the segment for us, which is
991 * reflected in EndPos, we return a pointer to just the end of the
992 * xlog-switch record.
993 */
994 if (inserted)
995 {
998 {
1000
1001 if (offset == EndPos % XLOG_BLCKSZ)
1003 else
1005 }
1006 }
1007 }
1008
1009#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
1010 if (XLOG_DEBUG)
1011 {
1013 XLogRecord *record;
1017 char *errormsg = NULL;
1019
1021
1023 appendStringInfo(&buf, "INSERT @ %X/%08X: ", LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(EndPos));
1024
1025 /*
1026 * We have to piece together the WAL record data from the XLogRecData
1027 * entries, so that we can pass it to the rm_desc function as one
1028 * contiguous chunk.
1029 */
1031 for (; rdata != NULL; rdata = rdata->next)
1033
1034 /* We also need temporary space to decode the record. */
1035 record = (XLogRecord *) recordBuf.data;
1038
1039 if (!debug_reader)
1041 XL_ROUTINE(.page_read = NULL,
1042 .segment_open = NULL,
1043 .segment_close = NULL),
1044 NULL);
1045 if (!debug_reader)
1046 {
1047 appendStringInfoString(&buf, "error decoding record: out of memory while allocating a WAL reading processor");
1048 }
1050 decoded,
1051 record,
1052 EndPos,
1053 &errormsg))
1054 {
1055 appendStringInfo(&buf, "error decoding record: %s",
1056 errormsg ? errormsg : "no error message");
1057 }
1058 else
1059 {
1060 appendStringInfoString(&buf, " - ");
1061
1062 debug_reader->record = decoded;
1064 debug_reader->record = NULL;
1065 }
1066 elog(LOG, "%s", buf.data);
1067
1068 pfree(decoded);
1069 pfree(buf.data);
1070 pfree(recordBuf.data);
1072 }
1073#endif
1074
1075 /*
1076 * Update our global variables
1077 */
1080
1081 /* Report WAL traffic to the instrumentation. */
1082 if (inserted)
1083 {
1084 pgWalUsage.wal_bytes += rechdr->xl_tot_len;
1088
1089 /* Required for the flush of pending stats WAL data */
1090 pgstat_report_fixed = true;
1091 }
1092
1093 return EndPos;
1094}
1095
1096/*
1097 * Reserves the right amount of space for a record of given size from the WAL.
1098 * *StartPos is set to the beginning of the reserved section, *EndPos to
1099 * its end+1. *PrevPtr is set to the beginning of the previous record; it is
1100 * used to set the xl_prev of this record.
1101 *
1102 * This is the performance critical part of XLogInsert that must be serialized
1103 * across backends. The rest can happen mostly in parallel. Try to keep this
1104 * section as short as possible, insertpos_lck can be heavily contended on a
1105 * busy system.
1106 *
1107 * NB: The space calculation here must match the code in CopyXLogRecordToWAL,
1108 * where we actually copy the record to the reserved space.
1109 *
1110 * NB: Testing shows that XLogInsertRecord runs faster if this code is inlined;
1111 * however, because there are two call sites, the compiler is reluctant to
1112 * inline. We use pg_attribute_always_inline here to try to convince it.
1113 */
1117{
1122
1123 size = MAXALIGN(size);
1124
1125 /* All (non xlog-switch) records should contain data. */
1126 Assert(size > SizeOfXLogRecord);
1127
1128 /*
1129 * The duration the spinlock needs to be held is minimized by minimizing
1130 * the calculations that have to be done while holding the lock. The
1131 * current tip of reserved WAL is kept in CurrBytePos, as a byte position
1132 * that only counts "usable" bytes in WAL, that is, it excludes all WAL
1133 * page headers. The mapping between "usable" byte positions and physical
1134 * positions (XLogRecPtrs) can be done outside the locked region, and
1135 * because the usable byte position doesn't include any headers, reserving
1136 * X bytes from WAL is almost as simple as "CurrBytePos += X".
1137 */
1138 SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1139
1140 startbytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
1141 endbytepos = startbytepos + size;
1142 prevbytepos = Insert->PrevBytePos;
1143 Insert->CurrBytePos = endbytepos;
1144 Insert->PrevBytePos = startbytepos;
1145
1146 SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1147
1151
1152 /*
1153 * Check that the conversions between "usable byte positions" and
1154 * XLogRecPtrs work consistently in both directions.
1155 */
1159}
1160
1161/*
1162 * Like ReserveXLogInsertLocation(), but for an xlog-switch record.
1163 *
1164 * A log-switch record is handled slightly differently. The rest of the
1165 * segment will be reserved for this insertion, as indicated by the returned
1166 * *EndPos value. However, if we are already at the beginning of the current
1167 * segment, *StartPos and *EndPos are set to the current location without
1168 * reserving any space, and the function returns false.
1169*/
1170static bool
1172{
1178 XLogRecPtr ptr;
1180
1181 /*
1182 * These calculations are a bit heavy-weight to be done while holding a
1183 * spinlock, but since we're holding all the WAL insertion locks, there
1184 * are no other inserters competing for it. GetXLogInsertRecPtr() does
1185 * compete for it, but that's not called very frequently.
1186 */
1187 SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1188
1189 startbytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
1190
1192 if (XLogSegmentOffset(ptr, wal_segment_size) == 0)
1193 {
1194 SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1195 *EndPos = *StartPos = ptr;
1196 return false;
1197 }
1198
1199 endbytepos = startbytepos + size;
1200 prevbytepos = Insert->PrevBytePos;
1201
1204
1207 {
1208 /* consume the rest of the segment */
1209 *EndPos += segleft;
1211 }
1212 Insert->CurrBytePos = endbytepos;
1213 Insert->PrevBytePos = startbytepos;
1214
1215 SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1216
1218
1223
1224 return true;
1225}
1226
1227/*
1228 * Subroutine of XLogInsertRecord. Copies a WAL record to an already-reserved
1229 * area in the WAL.
1230 */
1231static void
1234{
1235 char *currpos;
1236 int freespace;
1237 int written;
1240
1241 /*
1242 * Get a pointer to the right place in the right WAL buffer to start
1243 * inserting to.
1244 */
1245 CurrPos = StartPos;
1246 currpos = GetXLogBuffer(CurrPos, tli);
1247 freespace = INSERT_FREESPACE(CurrPos);
1248
1249 /*
1250 * there should be enough space for at least the first field (xl_tot_len)
1251 * on this page.
1252 */
1253 Assert(freespace >= sizeof(uint32));
1254
1255 /* Copy record data */
1256 written = 0;
1257 while (rdata != NULL)
1258 {
1259 const char *rdata_data = rdata->data;
1260 int rdata_len = rdata->len;
1261
1262 while (rdata_len > freespace)
1263 {
1264 /*
1265 * Write what fits on this page, and continue on the next page.
1266 */
1267 Assert(CurrPos % XLOG_BLCKSZ >= SizeOfXLogShortPHD || freespace == 0);
1268 memcpy(currpos, rdata_data, freespace);
1269 rdata_data += freespace;
1270 rdata_len -= freespace;
1271 written += freespace;
1272 CurrPos += freespace;
1273
1274 /*
1275 * Get pointer to beginning of next page, and set the xlp_rem_len
1276 * in the page header. Set XLP_FIRST_IS_CONTRECORD.
1277 *
1278 * It's safe to set the contrecord flag and xlp_rem_len without a
1279 * lock on the page. All the other flags were already set when the
1280 * page was initialized, in AdvanceXLInsertBuffer, and we're the
1281 * only backend that needs to set the contrecord flag.
1282 */
1283 currpos = GetXLogBuffer(CurrPos, tli);
1284 pagehdr = (XLogPageHeader) currpos;
1285 pagehdr->xlp_rem_len = write_len - written;
1286 pagehdr->xlp_info |= XLP_FIRST_IS_CONTRECORD;
1287
1288 /* skip over the page header */
1290 {
1292 currpos += SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
1293 }
1294 else
1295 {
1297 currpos += SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
1298 }
1299 freespace = INSERT_FREESPACE(CurrPos);
1300 }
1301
1302 Assert(CurrPos % XLOG_BLCKSZ >= SizeOfXLogShortPHD || rdata_len == 0);
1303 memcpy(currpos, rdata_data, rdata_len);
1304 currpos += rdata_len;
1305 CurrPos += rdata_len;
1306 freespace -= rdata_len;
1307 written += rdata_len;
1308
1309 rdata = rdata->next;
1310 }
1312
1313 /*
1314 * If this was an xlog-switch, it's not enough to write the switch record,
1315 * we also have to consume all the remaining space in the WAL segment. We
1316 * have already reserved that space, but we need to actually fill it.
1317 */
1319 {
1320 /* An xlog-switch record doesn't contain any data besides the header */
1322
1323 /* Assert that we did reserve the right amount of space */
1325
1326 /* Use up all the remaining space on the current page */
1327 CurrPos += freespace;
1328
1329 /*
1330 * Cause all remaining pages in the segment to be flushed, leaving the
1331 * XLog position where it should be, at the start of the next segment.
1332 * We do this one page at a time, to make sure we don't deadlock
1333 * against ourselves if wal_buffers < wal_segment_size.
1334 */
1335 while (CurrPos < EndPos)
1336 {
1337 /*
1338 * The minimal action to flush the page would be to call
1339 * WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(CurrPos) followed by
1340 * AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(...). The page would be left initialized
1341 * mostly to zeros, except for the page header (always the short
1342 * variant, as this is never a segment's first page).
1343 *
1344 * The large vistas of zeros are good for compressibility, but the
1345 * headers interrupting them every XLOG_BLCKSZ (with values that
1346 * differ from page to page) are not. The effect varies with
1347 * compression tool, but bzip2 for instance compresses about an
1348 * order of magnitude worse if those headers are left in place.
1349 *
1350 * Rather than complicating AdvanceXLInsertBuffer itself (which is
1351 * called in heavily-loaded circumstances as well as this lightly-
1352 * loaded one) with variant behavior, we just use GetXLogBuffer
1353 * (which itself calls the two methods we need) to get the pointer
1354 * and zero most of the page. Then we just zero the page header.
1355 */
1356 currpos = GetXLogBuffer(CurrPos, tli);
1357 MemSet(currpos, 0, SizeOfXLogShortPHD);
1358
1360 }
1361 }
1362 else
1363 {
1364 /* Align the end position, so that the next record starts aligned */
1366 }
1367
1368 if (CurrPos != EndPos)
1369 ereport(PANIC,
1371 errmsg_internal("space reserved for WAL record does not match what was written"));
1372}
1373
1374/*
1375 * Acquire a WAL insertion lock, for inserting to WAL.
1376 */
1377static void
1379{
1380 bool immed;
1381
1382 /*
1383 * It doesn't matter which of the WAL insertion locks we acquire, so try
1384 * the one we used last time. If the system isn't particularly busy, it's
1385 * a good bet that it's still available, and it's good to have some
1386 * affinity to a particular lock so that you don't unnecessarily bounce
1387 * cache lines between processes when there's no contention.
1388 *
1389 * If this is the first time through in this backend, pick a lock
1390 * (semi-)randomly. This allows the locks to be used evenly if you have a
1391 * lot of very short connections.
1392 */
1393 static int lockToTry = -1;
1394
1395 if (lockToTry == -1)
1398
1399 /*
1400 * The insertingAt value is initially set to 0, as we don't know our
1401 * insert location yet.
1402 */
1404 if (!immed)
1405 {
1406 /*
1407 * If we couldn't get the lock immediately, try another lock next
1408 * time. On a system with more insertion locks than concurrent
1409 * inserters, this causes all the inserters to eventually migrate to a
1410 * lock that no-one else is using. On a system with more inserters
1411 * than locks, it still helps to distribute the inserters evenly
1412 * across the locks.
1413 */
1415 }
1416}
1417
1418/*
1419 * Acquire all WAL insertion locks, to prevent other backends from inserting
1420 * to WAL.
1421 */
1422static void
1424{
1425 int i;
1426
1427 /*
1428 * When holding all the locks, all but the last lock's insertingAt
1429 * indicator is set to 0xFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFF, which is higher than any real
1430 * XLogRecPtr value, to make sure that no-one blocks waiting on those.
1431 */
1432 for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS - 1; i++)
1433 {
1438 }
1439 /* Variable value reset to 0 at release */
1441
1442 holdingAllLocks = true;
1443}
1444
1445/*
1446 * Release our insertion lock (or locks, if we're holding them all).
1447 *
1448 * NB: Reset all variables to 0, so they cause LWLockWaitForVar to block the
1449 * next time the lock is acquired.
1450 */
1451static void
1453{
1454 if (holdingAllLocks)
1455 {
1456 int i;
1457
1458 for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
1461 0);
1462
1463 holdingAllLocks = false;
1464 }
1465 else
1466 {
1469 0);
1470 }
1471}
1472
1473/*
1474 * Update our insertingAt value, to let others know that we've finished
1475 * inserting up to that point.
1476 */
1477static void
1479{
1480 if (holdingAllLocks)
1481 {
1482 /*
1483 * We use the last lock to mark our actual position, see comments in
1484 * WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive.
1485 */
1488 insertingAt);
1489 }
1490 else
1493 insertingAt);
1494}
1495
1496/*
1497 * Wait for any WAL insertions < upto to finish.
1498 *
1499 * Returns the location of the oldest insertion that is still in-progress.
1500 * Any WAL prior to that point has been fully copied into WAL buffers, and
1501 * can be flushed out to disk. Because this waits for any insertions older
1502 * than 'upto' to finish, the return value is always >= 'upto'.
1503 *
1504 * Note: When you are about to write out WAL, you must call this function
1505 * *before* acquiring WALWriteLock, to avoid deadlocks. This function might
1506 * need to wait for an insertion to finish (or at least advance to next
1507 * uninitialized page), and the inserter might need to evict an old WAL buffer
1508 * to make room for a new one, which in turn requires WALWriteLock.
1509 */
1510static XLogRecPtr
1512{
1518 int i;
1519
1520 if (MyProc == NULL)
1521 elog(PANIC, "cannot wait without a PGPROC structure");
1522
1523 /*
1524 * Check if there's any work to do. Use a barrier to ensure we get the
1525 * freshest value.
1526 */
1528 if (upto <= inserted)
1529 return inserted;
1530
1531 /* Read the current insert position */
1532 SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1533 bytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
1534 SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1536
1537 /*
1538 * No-one should request to flush a piece of WAL that hasn't even been
1539 * reserved yet. However, it can happen if there is a block with a bogus
1540 * LSN on disk, for example. XLogFlush checks for that situation and
1541 * complains, but only after the flush. Here we just assume that to mean
1542 * that all WAL that has been reserved needs to be finished. In this
1543 * corner-case, the return value can be smaller than 'upto' argument.
1544 */
1545 if (upto > reservedUpto)
1546 {
1547 ereport(LOG,
1548 errmsg("request to flush past end of generated WAL; request %X/%08X, current position %X/%08X",
1551 }
1552
1553 /*
1554 * Loop through all the locks, sleeping on any in-progress insert older
1555 * than 'upto'.
1556 *
1557 * finishedUpto is our return value, indicating the point upto which all
1558 * the WAL insertions have been finished. Initialize it to the head of
1559 * reserved WAL, and as we iterate through the insertion locks, back it
1560 * out for any insertion that's still in progress.
1561 */
1563 for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
1564 {
1566
1567 do
1568 {
1569 /*
1570 * See if this insertion is in progress. LWLockWaitForVar will
1571 * wait for the lock to be released, or for the 'value' to be set
1572 * by a LWLockUpdateVar call. When a lock is initially acquired,
1573 * its value is 0 (InvalidXLogRecPtr), which means that we don't
1574 * know where it's inserting yet. We will have to wait for it. If
1575 * it's a small insertion, the record will most likely fit on the
1576 * same page and the inserter will release the lock without ever
1577 * calling LWLockUpdateVar. But if it has to sleep, it will
1578 * advertise the insertion point with LWLockUpdateVar before
1579 * sleeping.
1580 *
1581 * In this loop we are only waiting for insertions that started
1582 * before WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish was called. The lack of
1583 * memory barriers in the loop means that we might see locks as
1584 * "unused" that have since become used. This is fine because
1585 * they only can be used for later insertions that we would not
1586 * want to wait on anyway. Not taking a lock to acquire the
1587 * current insertingAt value means that we might see older
1588 * insertingAt values. This is also fine, because if we read a
1589 * value too old, we will add ourselves to the wait queue, which
1590 * contains atomic operations.
1591 */
1592 if (LWLockWaitForVar(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock,
1595 {
1596 /* the lock was free, so no insertion in progress */
1598 break;
1599 }
1600
1601 /*
1602 * This insertion is still in progress. Have to wait, unless the
1603 * inserter has proceeded past 'upto'.
1604 */
1605 } while (insertingat < upto);
1606
1609 }
1610
1611 /*
1612 * Advance the limit we know to have been inserted and return the freshest
1613 * value we know of, which might be beyond what we requested if somebody
1614 * is concurrently doing this with an 'upto' pointer ahead of us.
1615 */
1617 finishedUpto);
1618
1619 return finishedUpto;
1620}
1621
1622/*
1623 * Get a pointer to the right location in the WAL buffer containing the
1624 * given XLogRecPtr.
1625 *
1626 * If the page is not initialized yet, it is initialized. That might require
1627 * evicting an old dirty buffer from the buffer cache, which means I/O.
1628 *
1629 * The caller must ensure that the page containing the requested location
1630 * isn't evicted yet, and won't be evicted. The way to ensure that is to
1631 * hold onto a WAL insertion lock with the insertingAt position set to
1632 * something <= ptr. GetXLogBuffer() will update insertingAt if it needs
1633 * to evict an old page from the buffer. (This means that once you call
1634 * GetXLogBuffer() with a given 'ptr', you must not access anything before
1635 * that point anymore, and must not call GetXLogBuffer() with an older 'ptr'
1636 * later, because older buffers might be recycled already)
1637 */
1638static char *
1640{
1641 int idx;
1642 XLogRecPtr endptr;
1643 static uint64 cachedPage = 0;
1644 static char *cachedPos = NULL;
1646
1647 /*
1648 * Fast path for the common case that we need to access again the same
1649 * page as last time.
1650 */
1651 if (ptr / XLOG_BLCKSZ == cachedPage)
1652 {
1654 Assert(((XLogPageHeader) cachedPos)->xlp_pageaddr == ptr - (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ));
1655 return cachedPos + ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1656 }
1657
1658 /*
1659 * The XLog buffer cache is organized so that a page is always loaded to a
1660 * particular buffer. That way we can easily calculate the buffer a given
1661 * page must be loaded into, from the XLogRecPtr alone.
1662 */
1663 idx = XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(ptr);
1664
1665 /*
1666 * See what page is loaded in the buffer at the moment. It could be the
1667 * page we're looking for, or something older. It can't be anything newer
1668 * - that would imply the page we're looking for has already been written
1669 * out to disk and evicted, and the caller is responsible for making sure
1670 * that doesn't happen.
1671 *
1672 * We don't hold a lock while we read the value. If someone is just about
1673 * to initialize or has just initialized the page, it's possible that we
1674 * get InvalidXLogRecPtr. That's ok, we'll grab the mapping lock (in
1675 * AdvanceXLInsertBuffer) and retry if we see anything other than the page
1676 * we're looking for.
1677 */
1678 expectedEndPtr = ptr;
1680
1682 if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
1683 {
1685
1686 /*
1687 * Before calling AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(), which can block, let others
1688 * know how far we're finished with inserting the record.
1689 *
1690 * NB: If 'ptr' points to just after the page header, advertise a
1691 * position at the beginning of the page rather than 'ptr' itself. If
1692 * there are no other insertions running, someone might try to flush
1693 * up to our advertised location. If we advertised a position after
1694 * the page header, someone might try to flush the page header, even
1695 * though page might actually not be initialized yet. As the first
1696 * inserter on the page, we are effectively responsible for making
1697 * sure that it's initialized, before we let insertingAt to move past
1698 * the page header.
1699 */
1700 if (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ == SizeOfXLogShortPHD &&
1703 else if (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ == SizeOfXLogLongPHD &&
1706 else
1707 initializedUpto = ptr;
1708
1710
1711 AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(ptr, tli, false);
1713
1714 if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
1715 elog(PANIC, "could not find WAL buffer for %X/%08X",
1716 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(ptr));
1717 }
1718 else
1719 {
1720 /*
1721 * Make sure the initialization of the page is visible to us, and
1722 * won't arrive later to overwrite the WAL data we write on the page.
1723 */
1725 }
1726
1727 /*
1728 * Found the buffer holding this page. Return a pointer to the right
1729 * offset within the page.
1730 */
1731 cachedPage = ptr / XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1733
1735 Assert(((XLogPageHeader) cachedPos)->xlp_pageaddr == ptr - (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ));
1736
1737 return cachedPos + ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1738}
1739
1740/*
1741 * Read WAL data directly from WAL buffers, if available. Returns the number
1742 * of bytes read successfully.
1743 *
1744 * Fewer than 'count' bytes may be read if some of the requested WAL data has
1745 * already been evicted.
1746 *
1747 * No locks are taken.
1748 *
1749 * Caller should ensure that it reads no further than LogwrtResult.Write
1750 * (which should have been updated by the caller when determining how far to
1751 * read). The 'tli' argument is only used as a convenient safety check so that
1752 * callers do not read from WAL buffers on a historical timeline.
1753 */
1754Size
1756 TimeLineID tli)
1757{
1758 char *pdst = dstbuf;
1759 XLogRecPtr recptr = startptr;
1761 Size nbytes = count;
1762
1764 return 0;
1765
1766 Assert(XLogRecPtrIsValid(startptr));
1767
1768 /*
1769 * Caller should ensure that the requested data has been inserted into WAL
1770 * buffers before we try to read it.
1771 */
1773 if (startptr + count > inserted)
1774 ereport(ERROR,
1775 errmsg("cannot read past end of generated WAL: requested %X/%08X, current position %X/%08X",
1776 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(startptr + count),
1778
1779 /*
1780 * Loop through the buffers without a lock. For each buffer, atomically
1781 * read and verify the end pointer, then copy the data out, and finally
1782 * re-read and re-verify the end pointer.
1783 *
1784 * Once a page is evicted, it never returns to the WAL buffers, so if the
1785 * end pointer matches the expected end pointer before and after we copy
1786 * the data, then the right page must have been present during the data
1787 * copy. Read barriers are necessary to ensure that the data copy actually
1788 * happens between the two verification steps.
1789 *
1790 * If either verification fails, we simply terminate the loop and return
1791 * with the data that had been already copied out successfully.
1792 */
1793 while (nbytes > 0)
1794 {
1795 uint32 offset = recptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1798 XLogRecPtr endptr;
1799 const char *page;
1800 const char *psrc;
1802
1803 /*
1804 * Calculate the end pointer we expect in the xlblocks array if the
1805 * correct page is present.
1806 */
1807 expectedEndPtr = recptr + (XLOG_BLCKSZ - offset);
1808
1809 /*
1810 * First verification step: check that the correct page is present in
1811 * the WAL buffers.
1812 */
1814 if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
1815 break;
1816
1817 /*
1818 * The correct page is present (or was at the time the endptr was
1819 * read; must re-verify later). Calculate pointer to source data and
1820 * determine how much data to read from this page.
1821 */
1822 page = XLogCtl->pages + idx * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1823 psrc = page + offset;
1824 npagebytes = Min(nbytes, XLOG_BLCKSZ - offset);
1825
1826 /*
1827 * Ensure that the data copy and the first verification step are not
1828 * reordered.
1829 */
1831
1832 /* data copy */
1834
1835 /*
1836 * Ensure that the data copy and the second verification step are not
1837 * reordered.
1838 */
1840
1841 /*
1842 * Second verification step: check that the page we read from wasn't
1843 * evicted while we were copying the data.
1844 */
1846 if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
1847 break;
1848
1849 pdst += npagebytes;
1850 recptr += npagebytes;
1851 nbytes -= npagebytes;
1852 }
1853
1854 Assert(pdst - dstbuf <= count);
1855
1856 return pdst - dstbuf;
1857}
1858
1859/*
1860 * Converts a "usable byte position" to XLogRecPtr. A usable byte position
1861 * is the position starting from the beginning of WAL, excluding all WAL
1862 * page headers.
1863 */
1864static XLogRecPtr
1866{
1871 XLogRecPtr result;
1872
1875
1877 {
1878 /* fits on first page of segment */
1880 }
1881 else
1882 {
1883 /* account for the first page on segment with long header */
1886
1889
1891 }
1892
1894
1895 return result;
1896}
1897
1898/*
1899 * Like XLogBytePosToRecPtr, but if the position is at a page boundary,
1900 * returns a pointer to the beginning of the page (ie. before page header),
1901 * not to where the first xlog record on that page would go to. This is used
1902 * when converting a pointer to the end of a record.
1903 */
1904static XLogRecPtr
1906{
1911 XLogRecPtr result;
1912
1915
1917 {
1918 /* fits on first page of segment */
1919 if (bytesleft == 0)
1920 seg_offset = 0;
1921 else
1923 }
1924 else
1925 {
1926 /* account for the first page on segment with long header */
1929
1932
1933 if (bytesleft == 0)
1935 else
1937 }
1938
1940
1941 return result;
1942}
1943
1944/*
1945 * Convert an XLogRecPtr to a "usable byte position".
1946 */
1947static uint64
1949{
1952 uint32 offset;
1953 uint64 result;
1954
1956
1958 offset = ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1959
1960 if (fullpages == 0)
1961 {
1962 result = fullsegs * UsableBytesInSegment;
1963 if (offset > 0)
1964 {
1965 Assert(offset >= SizeOfXLogLongPHD);
1966 result += offset - SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
1967 }
1968 }
1969 else
1970 {
1971 result = fullsegs * UsableBytesInSegment +
1972 (XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD) + /* account for first page */
1973 (fullpages - 1) * UsableBytesInPage; /* full pages */
1974 if (offset > 0)
1975 {
1976 Assert(offset >= SizeOfXLogShortPHD);
1977 result += offset - SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
1978 }
1979 }
1980
1981 return result;
1982}
1983
1984/*
1985 * Initialize XLOG buffers, writing out old buffers if they still contain
1986 * unwritten data, upto the page containing 'upto'. Or if 'opportunistic' is
1987 * true, initialize as many pages as we can without having to write out
1988 * unwritten data. Any new pages are initialized to zeros, with pages headers
1989 * initialized properly.
1990 */
1991static void
1993{
1995 int nextidx;
2001 int npages pg_attribute_unused() = 0;
2002
2004
2005 /*
2006 * Now that we have the lock, check if someone initialized the page
2007 * already.
2008 */
2010 {
2012
2013 /*
2014 * Get ending-offset of the buffer page we need to replace (this may
2015 * be zero if the buffer hasn't been used yet). Fall through if it's
2016 * already written out.
2017 */
2020 {
2021 /*
2022 * Nope, got work to do. If we just want to pre-initialize as much
2023 * as we can without flushing, give up now.
2024 */
2025 if (opportunistic)
2026 break;
2027
2028 /* Advance shared memory write request position */
2033
2034 /*
2035 * Acquire an up-to-date LogwrtResult value and see if we still
2036 * need to write it or if someone else already did.
2037 */
2040 {
2041 /*
2042 * Must acquire write lock. Release WALBufMappingLock first,
2043 * to make sure that all insertions that we need to wait for
2044 * can finish (up to this same position). Otherwise we risk
2045 * deadlock.
2046 */
2048
2050
2052
2055 {
2056 /* OK, someone wrote it already */
2058 }
2059 else
2060 {
2061 /* Have to write it ourselves */
2063 WriteRqst.Write = OldPageRqstPtr;
2064 WriteRqst.Flush = 0;
2065 XLogWrite(WriteRqst, tli, false);
2069
2070 /*
2071 * Required for the flush of pending stats WAL data, per
2072 * update of pgWalUsage.
2073 */
2074 pgstat_report_fixed = true;
2075 }
2076 /* Re-acquire WALBufMappingLock and retry */
2078 continue;
2079 }
2080 }
2081
2082 /*
2083 * Now the next buffer slot is free and we can set it up to be the
2084 * next output page.
2085 */
2088
2090
2092
2093 /*
2094 * Mark the xlblock with InvalidXLogRecPtr and issue a write barrier
2095 * before initializing. Otherwise, the old page may be partially
2096 * zeroed but look valid.
2097 */
2100
2101 /*
2102 * Be sure to re-zero the buffer so that bytes beyond what we've
2103 * written will look like zeroes and not valid XLOG records...
2104 */
2106
2107 /*
2108 * Fill the new page's header
2109 */
2110 NewPage->xlp_magic = XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC;
2111
2112 /* NewPage->xlp_info = 0; */ /* done by memset */
2113 NewPage->xlp_tli = tli;
2114 NewPage->xlp_pageaddr = NewPageBeginPtr;
2115
2116 /* NewPage->xlp_rem_len = 0; */ /* done by memset */
2117
2118 /*
2119 * If online backup is not in progress, mark the header to indicate
2120 * that WAL records beginning in this page have removable backup
2121 * blocks. This allows the WAL archiver to know whether it is safe to
2122 * compress archived WAL data by transforming full-block records into
2123 * the non-full-block format. It is sufficient to record this at the
2124 * page level because we force a page switch (in fact a segment
2125 * switch) when starting a backup, so the flag will be off before any
2126 * records can be written during the backup. At the end of a backup,
2127 * the last page will be marked as all unsafe when perhaps only part
2128 * is unsafe, but at worst the archiver would miss the opportunity to
2129 * compress a few records.
2130 */
2131 if (Insert->runningBackups == 0)
2132 NewPage->xlp_info |= XLP_BKP_REMOVABLE;
2133
2134 /*
2135 * If first page of an XLOG segment file, make it a long header.
2136 */
2137 if ((XLogSegmentOffset(NewPage->xlp_pageaddr, wal_segment_size)) == 0)
2138 {
2140
2142 NewLongPage->xlp_seg_size = wal_segment_size;
2143 NewLongPage->xlp_xlog_blcksz = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
2144 NewPage->xlp_info |= XLP_LONG_HEADER;
2145 }
2146
2147 /*
2148 * Make sure the initialization of the page becomes visible to others
2149 * before the xlblocks update. GetXLogBuffer() reads xlblocks without
2150 * holding a lock.
2151 */
2153
2156
2157 npages++;
2158 }
2160
2161#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
2162 if (XLOG_DEBUG && npages > 0)
2163 {
2164 elog(DEBUG1, "initialized %d pages, up to %X/%08X",
2166 }
2167#endif
2168}
2169
2170/*
2171 * Calculate CheckPointSegments based on max_wal_size_mb and
2172 * checkpoint_completion_target.
2173 */
2174static void
2176{
2177 double target;
2178
2179 /*-------
2180 * Calculate the distance at which to trigger a checkpoint, to avoid
2181 * exceeding max_wal_size_mb. This is based on two assumptions:
2182 *
2183 * a) we keep WAL for only one checkpoint cycle (prior to PG11 we kept
2184 * WAL for two checkpoint cycles to allow us to recover from the
2185 * secondary checkpoint if the first checkpoint failed, though we
2186 * only did this on the primary anyway, not on standby. Keeping just
2187 * one checkpoint simplifies processing and reduces disk space in
2188 * many smaller databases.)
2189 * b) during checkpoint, we consume checkpoint_completion_target *
2190 * number of segments consumed between checkpoints.
2191 *-------
2192 */
2195
2196 /* round down */
2197 CheckPointSegments = (int) target;
2198
2199 if (CheckPointSegments < 1)
2201}
2202
2203void
2209
2210void
2216
2217bool
2219{
2221 {
2222 GUC_check_errdetail("The WAL segment size must be a power of two between 1 MB and 1 GB.");
2223 return false;
2224 }
2225
2226 return true;
2227}
2228
2229/*
2230 * At a checkpoint, how many WAL segments to recycle as preallocated future
2231 * XLOG segments? Returns the highest segment that should be preallocated.
2232 */
2233static XLogSegNo
2235{
2238 double distance;
2240
2241 /*
2242 * Calculate the segment numbers that min_wal_size_mb and max_wal_size_mb
2243 * correspond to. Always recycle enough segments to meet the minimum, and
2244 * remove enough segments to stay below the maximum.
2245 */
2250
2251 /*
2252 * Between those limits, recycle enough segments to get us through to the
2253 * estimated end of next checkpoint.
2254 *
2255 * To estimate where the next checkpoint will finish, assume that the
2256 * system runs steadily consuming CheckPointDistanceEstimate bytes between
2257 * every checkpoint.
2258 */
2260 /* add 10% for good measure. */
2261 distance *= 1.10;
2262
2263 recycleSegNo = (XLogSegNo) ceil(((double) lastredoptr + distance) /
2265
2266 if (recycleSegNo < minSegNo)
2268 if (recycleSegNo > maxSegNo)
2270
2271 return recycleSegNo;
2272}
2273
2274/*
2275 * Check whether we've consumed enough xlog space that a checkpoint is needed.
2276 *
2277 * new_segno indicates a log file that has just been filled up (or read
2278 * during recovery). We measure the distance from RedoRecPtr to new_segno
2279 * and see if that exceeds CheckPointSegments.
2280 *
2281 * Note: it is caller's responsibility that RedoRecPtr is up-to-date.
2282 */
2283bool
2285{
2287
2289
2291 return true;
2292 return false;
2293}
2294
2295/*
2296 * Write and/or fsync the log at least as far as WriteRqst indicates.
2297 *
2298 * If flexible == true, we don't have to write as far as WriteRqst, but
2299 * may stop at any convenient boundary (such as a cache or logfile boundary).
2300 * This option allows us to avoid uselessly issuing multiple writes when a
2301 * single one would do.
2302 *
2303 * Must be called with WALWriteLock held. WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(WriteRqst)
2304 * must be called before grabbing the lock, to make sure the data is ready to
2305 * write.
2306 */
2307static void
2309{
2310 bool ispartialpage;
2311 bool last_iteration;
2312 bool finishing_seg;
2313 int curridx;
2314 int npages;
2315 int startidx;
2317
2318 /* We should always be inside a critical section here */
2320
2321 /*
2322 * Update local LogwrtResult (caller probably did this already, but...)
2323 */
2325
2326 /*
2327 * Since successive pages in the xlog cache are consecutively allocated,
2328 * we can usually gather multiple pages together and issue just one
2329 * write() call. npages is the number of pages we have determined can be
2330 * written together; startidx is the cache block index of the first one,
2331 * and startoffset is the file offset at which it should go. The latter
2332 * two variables are only valid when npages > 0, but we must initialize
2333 * all of them to keep the compiler quiet.
2334 */
2335 npages = 0;
2336 startidx = 0;
2337 startoffset = 0;
2338
2339 /*
2340 * Within the loop, curridx is the cache block index of the page to
2341 * consider writing. Begin at the buffer containing the next unwritten
2342 * page, or last partially written page.
2343 */
2345
2346 while (LogwrtResult.Write < WriteRqst.Write)
2347 {
2348 /*
2349 * Make sure we're not ahead of the insert process. This could happen
2350 * if we're passed a bogus WriteRqst.Write that is past the end of the
2351 * last page that's been initialized by AdvanceXLInsertBuffer.
2352 */
2354
2355 if (LogwrtResult.Write >= EndPtr)
2356 elog(PANIC, "xlog write request %X/%08X is past end of log %X/%08X",
2359
2360 /* Advance LogwrtResult.Write to end of current buffer page */
2363
2366 {
2367 /*
2368 * Switch to new logfile segment. We cannot have any pending
2369 * pages here (since we dump what we have at segment end).
2370 */
2371 Assert(npages == 0);
2372 if (openLogFile >= 0)
2373 XLogFileClose();
2376 openLogTLI = tli;
2377
2378 /* create/use new log file */
2381 }
2382
2383 /* Make sure we have the current logfile open */
2384 if (openLogFile < 0)
2385 {
2388 openLogTLI = tli;
2391 }
2392
2393 /* Add current page to the set of pending pages-to-dump */
2394 if (npages == 0)
2395 {
2396 /* first of group */
2397 startidx = curridx;
2400 }
2401 npages++;
2402
2403 /*
2404 * Dump the set if this will be the last loop iteration, or if we are
2405 * at the last page of the cache area (since the next page won't be
2406 * contiguous in memory), or if we are at the end of the logfile
2407 * segment.
2408 */
2410
2413
2414 if (last_iteration ||
2417 {
2418 char *from;
2419 Size nbytes;
2420 Size nleft;
2423
2424 /* OK to write the page(s) */
2425 from = XLogCtl->pages + startidx * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ;
2426 nbytes = npages * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ;
2427 nleft = nbytes;
2428 do
2429 {
2430 errno = 0;
2431
2432 /*
2433 * Measure I/O timing to write WAL data, for pg_stat_io.
2434 */
2436
2440
2442 IOOP_WRITE, start, 1, written);
2443
2444 if (written <= 0)
2445 {
2446 char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
2447 int save_errno;
2448
2449 if (errno == EINTR)
2450 continue;
2451
2452 save_errno = errno;
2455 errno = save_errno;
2456 ereport(PANIC,
2458 errmsg("could not write to log file \"%s\" at offset %u, length %zu: %m",
2460 }
2461 nleft -= written;
2462 from += written;
2464 } while (nleft > 0);
2465
2466 npages = 0;
2467
2468 /*
2469 * If we just wrote the whole last page of a logfile segment,
2470 * fsync the segment immediately. This avoids having to go back
2471 * and re-open prior segments when an fsync request comes along
2472 * later. Doing it here ensures that one and only one backend will
2473 * perform this fsync.
2474 *
2475 * This is also the right place to notify the Archiver that the
2476 * segment is ready to copy to archival storage, and to update the
2477 * timer for archive_timeout, and to signal for a checkpoint if
2478 * too many logfile segments have been used since the last
2479 * checkpoint.
2480 */
2481 if (finishing_seg)
2482 {
2484
2485 /* signal that we need to wakeup walsenders later */
2487
2488 LogwrtResult.Flush = LogwrtResult.Write; /* end of page */
2489
2490 if (XLogArchivingActive())
2492
2495
2496 /*
2497 * Request a checkpoint if we've consumed too much xlog since
2498 * the last one. For speed, we first check using the local
2499 * copy of RedoRecPtr, which might be out of date; if it looks
2500 * like a checkpoint is needed, forcibly update RedoRecPtr and
2501 * recheck.
2502 */
2504 {
2505 (void) GetRedoRecPtr();
2508 }
2509 }
2510 }
2511
2512 if (ispartialpage)
2513 {
2514 /* Only asked to write a partial page */
2516 break;
2517 }
2519
2520 /* If flexible, break out of loop as soon as we wrote something */
2521 if (flexible && npages == 0)
2522 break;
2523 }
2524
2525 Assert(npages == 0);
2526
2527 /*
2528 * If asked to flush, do so
2529 */
2530 if (LogwrtResult.Flush < WriteRqst.Flush &&
2532 {
2533 /*
2534 * Could get here without iterating above loop, in which case we might
2535 * have no open file or the wrong one. However, we do not need to
2536 * fsync more than one file.
2537 */
2540 {
2541 if (openLogFile >= 0 &&
2544 XLogFileClose();
2545 if (openLogFile < 0)
2546 {
2549 openLogTLI = tli;
2552 }
2553
2555 }
2556
2557 /* signal that we need to wakeup walsenders later */
2559
2561 }
2562
2563 /*
2564 * Update shared-memory status
2565 *
2566 * We make sure that the shared 'request' values do not fall behind the
2567 * 'result' values. This is not absolutely essential, but it saves some
2568 * code in a couple of places.
2569 */
2576
2577 /*
2578 * We write Write first, bar, then Flush. When reading, the opposite must
2579 * be done (with a matching barrier in between), so that we always see a
2580 * Flush value that trails behind the Write value seen.
2581 */
2585
2586#ifdef USE_ASSERT_CHECKING
2587 {
2591
2597
2598 /* WAL written to disk is always ahead of WAL flushed */
2599 Assert(Write >= Flush);
2600
2601 /* WAL inserted to buffers is always ahead of WAL written */
2602 Assert(Insert >= Write);
2603 }
2604#endif
2605}
2606
2607/*
2608 * Record the LSN for an asynchronous transaction commit/abort
2609 * and nudge the WALWriter if there is work for it to do.
2610 * (This should not be called for synchronous commits.)
2611 */
2612void
2614{
2615 XLogRecPtr WriteRqstPtr = asyncXactLSN;
2616 bool sleeping;
2617 bool wakeup = false;
2619
2623 if (XLogCtl->asyncXactLSN < asyncXactLSN)
2624 XLogCtl->asyncXactLSN = asyncXactLSN;
2626
2627 /*
2628 * If somebody else already called this function with a more aggressive
2629 * LSN, they will have done what we needed (and perhaps more).
2630 */
2631 if (asyncXactLSN <= prevAsyncXactLSN)
2632 return;
2633
2634 /*
2635 * If the WALWriter is sleeping, kick it to make it come out of low-power
2636 * mode, so that this async commit will reach disk within the expected
2637 * amount of time. Otherwise, determine whether it has enough WAL
2638 * available to flush, the same way that XLogBackgroundFlush() does.
2639 */
2640 if (sleeping)
2641 wakeup = true;
2642 else
2643 {
2644 int flushblocks;
2645
2647
2648 flushblocks =
2650
2652 wakeup = true;
2653 }
2654
2655 if (wakeup)
2656 {
2657 volatile PROC_HDR *procglobal = ProcGlobal;
2658 ProcNumber walwriterProc = procglobal->walwriterProc;
2659
2660 if (walwriterProc != INVALID_PROC_NUMBER)
2661 SetLatch(&GetPGProcByNumber(walwriterProc)->procLatch);
2662 }
2663}
2664
2665/*
2666 * Record the LSN up to which we can remove WAL because it's not required by
2667 * any replication slot.
2668 */
2669void
2676
2677
2678/*
2679 * Return the oldest LSN we must retain to satisfy the needs of some
2680 * replication slot.
2681 */
2682static XLogRecPtr
2684{
2685 XLogRecPtr retval;
2686
2690
2691 return retval;
2692}
2693
2694/*
2695 * Advance minRecoveryPoint in control file.
2696 *
2697 * If we crash during recovery, we must reach this point again before the
2698 * database is consistent.
2699 *
2700 * If 'force' is true, 'lsn' argument is ignored. Otherwise, minRecoveryPoint
2701 * is only updated if it's not already greater than or equal to 'lsn'.
2702 */
2703static void
2705{
2706 /* Quick check using our local copy of the variable */
2707 if (!updateMinRecoveryPoint || (!force && lsn <= LocalMinRecoveryPoint))
2708 return;
2709
2710 /*
2711 * An invalid minRecoveryPoint means that we need to recover all the WAL,
2712 * i.e., we're doing crash recovery. We never modify the control file's
2713 * value in that case, so we can short-circuit future checks here too. The
2714 * local values of minRecoveryPoint and minRecoveryPointTLI should not be
2715 * updated until crash recovery finishes. We only do this for the startup
2716 * process as it should not update its own reference of minRecoveryPoint
2717 * until it has finished crash recovery to make sure that all WAL
2718 * available is replayed in this case. This also saves from extra locks
2719 * taken on the control file from the startup process.
2720 */
2722 {
2723 updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
2724 return;
2725 }
2726
2728
2729 /* update local copy */
2732
2734 updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
2735 else if (force || LocalMinRecoveryPoint < lsn)
2736 {
2739
2740 /*
2741 * To avoid having to update the control file too often, we update it
2742 * all the way to the last record being replayed, even though 'lsn'
2743 * would suffice for correctness. This also allows the 'force' case
2744 * to not need a valid 'lsn' value.
2745 *
2746 * Another important reason for doing it this way is that the passed
2747 * 'lsn' value could be bogus, i.e., past the end of available WAL, if
2748 * the caller got it from a corrupted heap page. Accepting such a
2749 * value as the min recovery point would prevent us from coming up at
2750 * all. Instead, we just log a warning and continue with recovery.
2751 * (See also the comments about corrupt LSNs in XLogFlush.)
2752 */
2754 if (!force && newMinRecoveryPoint < lsn)
2755 elog(WARNING,
2756 "xlog min recovery request %X/%08X is past current point %X/%08X",
2758
2759 /* update control file */
2761 {
2767
2769 errmsg_internal("updated min recovery point to %X/%08X on timeline %u",
2772 }
2773 }
2775}
2776
2777/*
2778 * Ensure that all XLOG data through the given position is flushed to disk.
2779 *
2780 * NOTE: this differs from XLogWrite mainly in that the WALWriteLock is not
2781 * already held, and we try to avoid acquiring it if possible.
2782 */
2783void
2785{
2789
2790 /*
2791 * During REDO, we are reading not writing WAL. Therefore, instead of
2792 * trying to flush the WAL, we should update minRecoveryPoint instead. We
2793 * test XLogInsertAllowed(), not InRecovery, because we need checkpointer
2794 * to act this way too, and because when it tries to write the
2795 * end-of-recovery checkpoint, it should indeed flush.
2796 */
2797 if (!XLogInsertAllowed())
2798 {
2799 UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(record, false);
2800 return;
2801 }
2802
2803 /* Quick exit if already known flushed */
2804 if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
2805 return;
2806
2807#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
2808 if (XLOG_DEBUG)
2809 elog(LOG, "xlog flush request %X/%08X; write %X/%08X; flush %X/%08X",
2810 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(record),
2813#endif
2814
2816
2817 /*
2818 * Since fsync is usually a horribly expensive operation, we try to
2819 * piggyback as much data as we can on each fsync: if we see any more data
2820 * entered into the xlog buffer, we'll write and fsync that too, so that
2821 * the final value of LogwrtResult.Flush is as large as possible. This
2822 * gives us some chance of avoiding another fsync immediately after.
2823 */
2824
2825 /* initialize to given target; may increase below */
2826 WriteRqstPtr = record;
2827
2828 /*
2829 * Now wait until we get the write lock, or someone else does the flush
2830 * for us.
2831 */
2832 for (;;)
2833 {
2835
2836 /* done already? */
2838 if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
2839 break;
2840
2841 /*
2842 * Before actually performing the write, wait for all in-flight
2843 * insertions to the pages we're about to write to finish.
2844 */
2846 if (WriteRqstPtr < XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write)
2850
2851 /*
2852 * Try to get the write lock. If we can't get it immediately, wait
2853 * until it's released, and recheck if we still need to do the flush
2854 * or if the backend that held the lock did it for us already. This
2855 * helps to maintain a good rate of group committing when the system
2856 * is bottlenecked by the speed of fsyncing.
2857 */
2859 {
2860 /*
2861 * The lock is now free, but we didn't acquire it yet. Before we
2862 * do, loop back to check if someone else flushed the record for
2863 * us already.
2864 */
2865 continue;
2866 }
2867
2868 /* Got the lock; recheck whether request is satisfied */
2870 if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
2871 {
2873 break;
2874 }
2875
2876 /*
2877 * Sleep before flush! By adding a delay here, we may give further
2878 * backends the opportunity to join the backlog of group commit
2879 * followers; this can significantly improve transaction throughput,
2880 * at the risk of increasing transaction latency.
2881 *
2882 * We do not sleep if enableFsync is not turned on, nor if there are
2883 * fewer than CommitSiblings other backends with active transactions.
2884 */
2885 if (CommitDelay > 0 && enableFsync &&
2887 {
2891
2892 /*
2893 * Re-check how far we can now flush the WAL. It's generally not
2894 * safe to call WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish while holding
2895 * WALWriteLock, because an in-progress insertion might need to
2896 * also grab WALWriteLock to make progress. But we know that all
2897 * the insertions up to insertpos have already finished, because
2898 * that's what the earlier WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish() returned.
2899 * We're only calling it again to allow insertpos to be moved
2900 * further forward, not to actually wait for anyone.
2901 */
2903 }
2904
2905 /* try to write/flush later additions to XLOG as well */
2906 WriteRqst.Write = insertpos;
2907 WriteRqst.Flush = insertpos;
2908
2909 XLogWrite(WriteRqst, insertTLI, false);
2910
2912 /* done */
2913 break;
2914 }
2915
2917
2918 /* wake up walsenders now that we've released heavily contended locks */
2920
2921 /*
2922 * If we flushed an LSN that someone was waiting for, notify the waiters.
2923 */
2924 if (waitLSNState &&
2928
2929 /*
2930 * If we still haven't flushed to the request point then we have a
2931 * problem; most likely, the requested flush point is past end of XLOG.
2932 * This has been seen to occur when a disk page has a corrupted LSN.
2933 *
2934 * Formerly we treated this as a PANIC condition, but that hurts the
2935 * system's robustness rather than helping it: we do not want to take down
2936 * the whole system due to corruption on one data page. In particular, if
2937 * the bad page is encountered again during recovery then we would be
2938 * unable to restart the database at all! (This scenario actually
2939 * happened in the field several times with 7.1 releases.) As of 8.4, bad
2940 * LSNs encountered during recovery are UpdateMinRecoveryPoint's problem;
2941 * the only time we can reach here during recovery is while flushing the
2942 * end-of-recovery checkpoint record, and we don't expect that to have a
2943 * bad LSN.
2944 *
2945 * Note that for calls from xact.c, the ERROR will be promoted to PANIC
2946 * since xact.c calls this routine inside a critical section. However,
2947 * calls from bufmgr.c are not within critical sections and so we will not
2948 * force a restart for a bad LSN on a data page.
2949 */
2950 if (LogwrtResult.Flush < record)
2951 elog(ERROR,
2952 "xlog flush request %X/%08X is not satisfied --- flushed only to %X/%08X",
2953 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(record),
2955
2956 /*
2957 * Cross-check XLogNeedsFlush(). Some of the checks of XLogFlush() and
2958 * XLogNeedsFlush() are duplicated, and this assertion ensures that these
2959 * remain consistent.
2960 */
2961 Assert(!XLogNeedsFlush(record));
2962}
2963
2964/*
2965 * Write & flush xlog, but without specifying exactly where to.
2966 *
2967 * We normally write only completed blocks; but if there is nothing to do on
2968 * that basis, we check for unwritten async commits in the current incomplete
2969 * block, and write through the latest one of those. Thus, if async commits
2970 * are not being used, we will write complete blocks only.
2971 *
2972 * If, based on the above, there's anything to write we do so immediately. But
2973 * to avoid calling fsync, fdatasync et. al. at a rate that'd impact
2974 * concurrent IO, we only flush WAL every wal_writer_delay ms, or if there's
2975 * more than wal_writer_flush_after unflushed blocks.
2976 *
2977 * We can guarantee that async commits reach disk after at most three
2978 * wal_writer_delay cycles. (When flushing complete blocks, we allow XLogWrite
2979 * to write "flexibly", meaning it can stop at the end of the buffer ring;
2980 * this makes a difference only with very high load or long wal_writer_delay,
2981 * but imposes one extra cycle for the worst case for async commits.)
2982 *
2983 * This routine is invoked periodically by the background walwriter process.
2984 *
2985 * Returns true if there was any work to do, even if we skipped flushing due
2986 * to wal_writer_delay/wal_writer_flush_after.
2987 */
2988bool
2990{
2992 bool flexible = true;
2993 static TimestampTz lastflush;
2995 int flushblocks;
2997
2998 /* XLOG doesn't need flushing during recovery */
2999 if (RecoveryInProgress())
3000 return false;
3001
3002 /*
3003 * Since we're not in recovery, InsertTimeLineID is set and can't change,
3004 * so we can read it without a lock.
3005 */
3007
3008 /* read updated LogwrtRqst */
3012
3013 /* back off to last completed page boundary */
3014 WriteRqst.Write -= WriteRqst.Write % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
3015
3016 /* if we have already flushed that far, consider async commit records */
3018 if (WriteRqst.Write <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
3019 {
3023 flexible = false; /* ensure it all gets written */
3024 }
3025
3026 /*
3027 * If already known flushed, we're done. Just need to check if we are
3028 * holding an open file handle to a logfile that's no longer in use,
3029 * preventing the file from being deleted.
3030 */
3031 if (WriteRqst.Write <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
3032 {
3033 if (openLogFile >= 0)
3034 {
3037 {
3038 XLogFileClose();
3039 }
3040 }
3041 return false;
3042 }
3043
3044 /*
3045 * Determine how far to flush WAL, based on the wal_writer_delay and
3046 * wal_writer_flush_after GUCs.
3047 *
3048 * Note that XLogSetAsyncXactLSN() performs similar calculation based on
3049 * wal_writer_flush_after, to decide when to wake us up. Make sure the
3050 * logic is the same in both places if you change this.
3051 */
3053 flushblocks =
3055
3056 if (WalWriterFlushAfter == 0 || lastflush == 0)
3057 {
3058 /* first call, or block based limits disabled */
3059 WriteRqst.Flush = WriteRqst.Write;
3060 lastflush = now;
3061 }
3063 {
3064 /*
3065 * Flush the writes at least every WalWriterDelay ms. This is
3066 * important to bound the amount of time it takes for an asynchronous
3067 * commit to hit disk.
3068 */
3069 WriteRqst.Flush = WriteRqst.Write;
3070 lastflush = now;
3071 }
3072 else if (flushblocks >= WalWriterFlushAfter)
3073 {
3074 /* exceeded wal_writer_flush_after blocks, flush */
3075 WriteRqst.Flush = WriteRqst.Write;
3076 lastflush = now;
3077 }
3078 else
3079 {
3080 /* no flushing, this time round */
3081 WriteRqst.Flush = 0;
3082 }
3083
3084#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
3085 if (XLOG_DEBUG)
3086 elog(LOG, "xlog bg flush request write %X/%08X; flush: %X/%08X, current is write %X/%08X; flush %X/%08X",
3091#endif
3092
3094
3095 /* now wait for any in-progress insertions to finish and get write lock */
3099 if (WriteRqst.Write > LogwrtResult.Write ||
3101 {
3103 }
3105
3107
3108 /* wake up walsenders now that we've released heavily contended locks */
3110
3111 /*
3112 * If we flushed an LSN that someone was waiting for, notify the waiters.
3113 */
3114 if (waitLSNState &&
3118
3119 /*
3120 * Great, done. To take some work off the critical path, try to initialize
3121 * as many of the no-longer-needed WAL buffers for future use as we can.
3122 */
3124
3125 /*
3126 * If we determined that we need to write data, but somebody else
3127 * wrote/flushed already, it should be considered as being active, to
3128 * avoid hibernating too early.
3129 */
3130 return true;
3131}
3132
3133/*
3134 * Test whether XLOG data has been flushed up to (at least) the given
3135 * position, or whether the minimum recovery point has been updated past
3136 * the given position.
3137 *
3138 * Returns true if a flush is still needed, or if the minimum recovery point
3139 * must be updated.
3140 *
3141 * It is possible that someone else is already in the process of flushing
3142 * that far, or has updated the minimum recovery point up to the given
3143 * position.
3144 */
3145bool
3147{
3148 /*
3149 * During recovery, we don't flush WAL but update minRecoveryPoint
3150 * instead. So "needs flush" is taken to mean whether minRecoveryPoint
3151 * would need to be updated.
3152 *
3153 * Using XLogInsertAllowed() rather than RecoveryInProgress() matters for
3154 * the case of an end-of-recovery checkpoint, where WAL data is flushed.
3155 * This check should be consistent with the one in XLogFlush().
3156 */
3157 if (!XLogInsertAllowed())
3158 {
3159 /* Quick exit if already known to be updated or cannot be updated */
3161 return false;
3162
3163 /*
3164 * An invalid minRecoveryPoint means that we need to recover all the
3165 * WAL, i.e., we're doing crash recovery. We never modify the control
3166 * file's value in that case, so we can short-circuit future checks
3167 * here too. This triggers a quick exit path for the startup process,
3168 * which cannot update its local copy of minRecoveryPoint as long as
3169 * it has not replayed all WAL available when doing crash recovery.
3170 */
3172 {
3173 updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
3174 return false;
3175 }
3176
3177 /*
3178 * Update local copy of minRecoveryPoint. But if the lock is busy,
3179 * just return a conservative guess.
3180 */
3182 return true;
3186
3187 /*
3188 * Check minRecoveryPoint for any other process than the startup
3189 * process doing crash recovery, which should not update the control
3190 * file value if crash recovery is still running.
3191 */
3193 updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
3194
3195 /* check again */
3197 return false;
3198 else
3199 return true;
3200 }
3201
3202 /* Quick exit if already known flushed */
3203 if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
3204 return false;
3205
3206 /* read LogwrtResult and update local state */
3208
3209 /* check again */
3210 if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
3211 return false;
3212
3213 return true;
3214}
3215
3216/*
3217 * Try to make a given XLOG file segment exist.
3218 *
3219 * logsegno: identify segment.
3220 *
3221 * *added: on return, true if this call raised the number of extant segments.
3222 *
3223 * path: on return, this char[MAXPGPATH] has the path to the logsegno file.
3224 *
3225 * Returns -1 or FD of opened file. A -1 here is not an error; a caller
3226 * wanting an open segment should attempt to open "path", which usually will
3227 * succeed. (This is weird, but it's efficient for the callers.)
3228 */
3229static int
3231 bool *added, char *path)
3232{
3233 char tmppath[MAXPGPATH];
3236 int fd;
3237 int save_errno;
3240
3241 Assert(logtli != 0);
3242
3244
3245 /*
3246 * Try to use existent file (checkpoint maker may have created it already)
3247 */
3248 *added = false;
3251 if (fd < 0)
3252 {
3253 if (errno != ENOENT)
3254 ereport(ERROR,
3256 errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
3257 }
3258 else
3259 return fd;
3260
3261 /*
3262 * Initialize an empty (all zeroes) segment. NOTE: it is possible that
3263 * another process is doing the same thing. If so, we will end up
3264 * pre-creating an extra log segment. That seems OK, and better than
3265 * holding the lock throughout this lengthy process.
3266 */
3267 elog(DEBUG2, "creating and filling new WAL file");
3268
3269 snprintf(tmppath, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/xlogtemp.%d", (int) getpid());
3270
3271 unlink(tmppath);
3272
3275
3276 /* do not use get_sync_bit() here --- want to fsync only at end of fill */
3278 if (fd < 0)
3279 ereport(ERROR,
3281 errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3282
3283 /* Measure I/O timing when initializing segment */
3285
3287 save_errno = 0;
3288 if (wal_init_zero)
3289 {
3290 ssize_t rc;
3291
3292 /*
3293 * Zero-fill the file. With this setting, we do this the hard way to
3294 * ensure that all the file space has really been allocated. On
3295 * platforms that allow "holes" in files, just seeking to the end
3296 * doesn't allocate intermediate space. This way, we know that we
3297 * have all the space and (after the fsync below) that all the
3298 * indirect blocks are down on disk. Therefore, fdatasync(2) or
3299 * O_DSYNC will be sufficient to sync future writes to the log file.
3300 */
3302
3303 if (rc < 0)
3304 save_errno = errno;
3305 }
3306 else
3307 {
3308 /*
3309 * Otherwise, seeking to the end and writing a solitary byte is
3310 * enough.
3311 */
3312 errno = 0;
3313 if (pg_pwrite(fd, "\0", 1, wal_segment_size - 1) != 1)
3314 {
3315 /* if write didn't set errno, assume no disk space */
3317 }
3318 }
3320
3321 /*
3322 * A full segment worth of data is written when using wal_init_zero. One
3323 * byte is written when not using it.
3324 */
3326 io_start, 1,
3328
3329 if (save_errno)
3330 {
3331 /*
3332 * If we fail to make the file, delete it to release disk space
3333 */
3334 unlink(tmppath);
3335
3336 close(fd);
3337
3338 errno = save_errno;
3339
3340 ereport(ERROR,
3342 errmsg("could not write to file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3343 }
3344
3345 /* Measure I/O timing when flushing segment */
3347
3349 if (pg_fsync(fd) != 0)
3350 {
3351 save_errno = errno;
3352 close(fd);
3353 errno = save_errno;
3354 ereport(ERROR,
3356 errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3357 }
3359
3361 IOOP_FSYNC, io_start, 1, 0);
3362
3363 if (close(fd) != 0)
3364 ereport(ERROR,
3366 errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3367
3368 /*
3369 * Now move the segment into place with its final name. Cope with
3370 * possibility that someone else has created the file while we were
3371 * filling ours: if so, use ours to pre-create a future log segment.
3372 */
3374
3375 /*
3376 * XXX: What should we use as max_segno? We used to use XLOGfileslop when
3377 * that was a constant, but that was always a bit dubious: normally, at a
3378 * checkpoint, XLOGfileslop was the offset from the checkpoint record, but
3379 * here, it was the offset from the insert location. We can't do the
3380 * normal XLOGfileslop calculation here because we don't have access to
3381 * the prior checkpoint's redo location. So somewhat arbitrarily, just use
3382 * CheckPointSegments.
3383 */
3386 logtli))
3387 {
3388 *added = true;
3389 elog(DEBUG2, "done creating and filling new WAL file");
3390 }
3391 else
3392 {
3393 /*
3394 * No need for any more future segments, or InstallXLogFileSegment()
3395 * failed to rename the file into place. If the rename failed, a
3396 * caller opening the file may fail.
3397 */
3398 unlink(tmppath);
3399 elog(DEBUG2, "abandoned new WAL file");
3400 }
3401
3402 return -1;
3403}
3404
3405/*
3406 * Create a new XLOG file segment, or open a pre-existing one.
3407 *
3408 * logsegno: identify segment to be created/opened.
3409 *
3410 * Returns FD of opened file.
3411 *
3412 * Note: errors here are ERROR not PANIC because we might or might not be
3413 * inside a critical section (eg, during checkpoint there is no reason to
3414 * take down the system on failure). They will promote to PANIC if we are
3415 * in a critical section.
3416 */
3417int
3419{
3420 bool ignore_added;
3421 char path[MAXPGPATH];
3422 int fd;
3423
3424 Assert(logtli != 0);
3425
3427 if (fd >= 0)
3428 return fd;
3429
3430 /* Now open original target segment (might not be file I just made) */
3433 if (fd < 0)
3434 ereport(ERROR,
3436 errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
3437 return fd;
3438}
3439
3440/*
3441 * Create a new XLOG file segment by copying a pre-existing one.
3442 *
3443 * destsegno: identify segment to be created.
3444 *
3445 * srcTLI, srcsegno: identify segment to be copied (could be from
3446 * a different timeline)
3447 *
3448 * upto: how much of the source file to copy (the rest is filled with
3449 * zeros)
3450 *
3451 * Currently this is only used during recovery, and so there are no locking
3452 * considerations. But we should be just as tense as XLogFileInit to avoid
3453 * emplacing a bogus file.
3454 */
3455static void
3458 int upto)
3459{
3460 char path[MAXPGPATH];
3461 char tmppath[MAXPGPATH];
3462 PGAlignedXLogBlock buffer;
3463 int srcfd;
3464 int fd;
3465 int nbytes;
3466
3467 /*
3468 * Open the source file
3469 */
3472 if (srcfd < 0)
3473 ereport(ERROR,
3475 errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
3476
3477 /*
3478 * Copy into a temp file name.
3479 */
3480 snprintf(tmppath, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/xlogtemp.%d", (int) getpid());
3481
3482 unlink(tmppath);
3483
3484 /* do not use get_sync_bit() here --- want to fsync only at end of fill */
3486 if (fd < 0)
3487 ereport(ERROR,
3489 errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3490
3491 /*
3492 * Do the data copying.
3493 */
3494 for (nbytes = 0; nbytes < wal_segment_size; nbytes += sizeof(buffer))
3495 {
3496 int nread;
3497
3498 nread = upto - nbytes;
3499
3500 /*
3501 * The part that is not read from the source file is filled with
3502 * zeros.
3503 */
3504 if (nread < sizeof(buffer))
3505 memset(buffer.data, 0, sizeof(buffer));
3506
3507 if (nread > 0)
3508 {
3509 int r;
3510
3511 if (nread > sizeof(buffer))
3512 nread = sizeof(buffer);
3514 r = read(srcfd, buffer.data, nread);
3515 if (r != nread)
3516 {
3517 if (r < 0)
3518 ereport(ERROR,
3520 errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": %m",
3521 path)));
3522 else
3523 ereport(ERROR,
3525 errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": read %d of %zu",
3526 path, r, (Size) nread)));
3527 }
3529 }
3530 errno = 0;
3532 if ((int) write(fd, buffer.data, sizeof(buffer)) != (int) sizeof(buffer))
3533 {
3534 int save_errno = errno;
3535
3536 /*
3537 * If we fail to make the file, delete it to release disk space
3538 */
3539 unlink(tmppath);
3540 /* if write didn't set errno, assume problem is no disk space */
3542
3543 ereport(ERROR,
3545 errmsg("could not write to file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3546 }
3548 }
3549
3551 if (pg_fsync(fd) != 0)
3554 errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3556
3557 if (CloseTransientFile(fd) != 0)
3558 ereport(ERROR,
3560 errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3561
3562 if (CloseTransientFile(srcfd) != 0)
3563 ereport(ERROR,
3565 errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", path)));
3566
3567 /*
3568 * Now move the segment into place with its final name.
3569 */
3571 elog(ERROR, "InstallXLogFileSegment should not have failed");
3572}
3573
3574/*
3575 * Install a new XLOG segment file as a current or future log segment.
3576 *
3577 * This is used both to install a newly-created segment (which has a temp
3578 * filename while it's being created) and to recycle an old segment.
3579 *
3580 * *segno: identify segment to install as (or first possible target).
3581 * When find_free is true, this is modified on return to indicate the
3582 * actual installation location or last segment searched.
3583 *
3584 * tmppath: initial name of file to install. It will be renamed into place.
3585 *
3586 * find_free: if true, install the new segment at the first empty segno
3587 * number at or after the passed numbers. If false, install the new segment
3588 * exactly where specified, deleting any existing segment file there.
3589 *
3590 * max_segno: maximum segment number to install the new file as. Fail if no
3591 * free slot is found between *segno and max_segno. (Ignored when find_free
3592 * is false.)
3593 *
3594 * tli: The timeline on which the new segment should be installed.
3595 *
3596 * Returns true if the file was installed successfully. false indicates that
3597 * max_segno limit was exceeded, the startup process has disabled this
3598 * function for now, or an error occurred while renaming the file into place.
3599 */
3600static bool
3603{
3604 char path[MAXPGPATH];
3605 struct stat stat_buf;
3606
3607 Assert(tli != 0);
3608
3609 XLogFilePath(path, tli, *segno, wal_segment_size);
3610
3613 {
3615 return false;
3616 }
3617
3618 if (!find_free)
3619 {
3620 /* Force installation: get rid of any pre-existing segment file */
3621 durable_unlink(path, DEBUG1);
3622 }
3623 else
3624 {
3625 /* Find a free slot to put it in */
3626 while (stat(path, &stat_buf) == 0)
3627 {
3628 if ((*segno) >= max_segno)
3629 {
3630 /* Failed to find a free slot within specified range */
3632 return false;
3633 }
3634 (*segno)++;
3635 XLogFilePath(path, tli, *segno, wal_segment_size);
3636 }
3637 }
3638
3639 Assert(access(path, F_OK) != 0 && errno == ENOENT);
3640 if (durable_rename(tmppath, path, LOG) != 0)
3641 {
3643 /* durable_rename already emitted log message */
3644 return false;
3645 }
3646
3648
3649 return true;
3650}
3651
3652/*
3653 * Open a pre-existing logfile segment for writing.
3654 */
3655int
3657{
3658 char path[MAXPGPATH];
3659 int fd;
3660
3661 XLogFilePath(path, tli, segno, wal_segment_size);
3662
3665 if (fd < 0)
3666 ereport(PANIC,
3668 errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
3669
3670 return fd;
3671}
3672
3673/*
3674 * Close the current logfile segment for writing.
3675 */
3676static void
3678{
3679 Assert(openLogFile >= 0);
3680
3681 /*
3682 * WAL segment files will not be re-read in normal operation, so we advise
3683 * the OS to release any cached pages. But do not do so if WAL archiving
3684 * or streaming is active, because archiver and walsender process could
3685 * use the cache to read the WAL segment.
3686 */
3687#if defined(USE_POSIX_FADVISE) && defined(POSIX_FADV_DONTNEED)
3688 if (!XLogIsNeeded() && (io_direct_flags & IO_DIRECT_WAL) == 0)
3690#endif
3691
3692 if (close(openLogFile) != 0)
3693 {
3694 char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
3695 int save_errno = errno;
3696
3698 errno = save_errno;
3699 ereport(PANIC,
3701 errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", xlogfname)));
3702 }
3703
3704 openLogFile = -1;
3706}
3707
3708/*
3709 * Preallocate log files beyond the specified log endpoint.
3710 *
3711 * XXX this is currently extremely conservative, since it forces only one
3712 * future log segment to exist, and even that only if we are 75% done with
3713 * the current one. This is only appropriate for very low-WAL-volume systems.
3714 * High-volume systems will be OK once they've built up a sufficient set of
3715 * recycled log segments, but the startup transient is likely to include
3716 * a lot of segment creations by foreground processes, which is not so good.
3717 *
3718 * XLogFileInitInternal() can ereport(ERROR). All known causes indicate big
3719 * trouble; for example, a full filesystem is one cause. The checkpoint WAL
3720 * and/or ControlFile updates already completed. If a RequestCheckpoint()
3721 * initiated the present checkpoint and an ERROR ends this function, the
3722 * command that called RequestCheckpoint() fails. That's not ideal, but it's
3723 * not worth contorting more functions to use caller-specified elevel values.
3724 * (With or without RequestCheckpoint(), an ERROR forestalls some inessential
3725 * reporting and resource reclamation.)
3726 */
3727static void
3729{
3731 int lf;
3732 bool added;
3733 char path[MAXPGPATH];
3734 uint64 offset;
3735
3737 return; /* unlocked check says no */
3738
3740 offset = XLogSegmentOffset(endptr - 1, wal_segment_size);
3741 if (offset >= (uint32) (0.75 * wal_segment_size))
3742 {
3743 _logSegNo++;
3744 lf = XLogFileInitInternal(_logSegNo, tli, &added, path);
3745 if (lf >= 0)
3746 close(lf);
3747 if (added)
3749 }
3750}
3751
3752/*
3753 * Throws an error if the given log segment has already been removed or
3754 * recycled. The caller should only pass a segment that it knows to have
3755 * existed while the server has been running, as this function always
3756 * succeeds if no WAL segments have been removed since startup.
3757 * 'tli' is only used in the error message.
3758 *
3759 * Note: this function guarantees to keep errno unchanged on return.
3760 * This supports callers that use this to possibly deliver a better
3761 * error message about a missing file, while still being able to throw
3762 * a normal file-access error afterwards, if this does return.
3763 */
3764void
3766{
3767 int save_errno = errno;
3768 XLogSegNo lastRemovedSegNo;
3769
3771 lastRemovedSegNo = XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo;
3773
3774 if (segno <= lastRemovedSegNo)
3775 {
3776 char filename[MAXFNAMELEN];
3777
3779 errno = save_errno;
3780 ereport(ERROR,
3782 errmsg("requested WAL segment %s has already been removed",
3783 filename)));
3784 }
3785 errno = save_errno;
3786}
3787
3788/*
3789 * Return the last WAL segment removed, or 0 if no segment has been removed
3790 * since startup.
3791 *
3792 * NB: the result can be out of date arbitrarily fast, the caller has to deal
3793 * with that.
3794 */
3797{
3798 XLogSegNo lastRemovedSegNo;
3799
3801 lastRemovedSegNo = XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo;
3803
3804 return lastRemovedSegNo;
3805}
3806
3807/*
3808 * Return the oldest WAL segment on the given TLI that still exists in
3809 * XLOGDIR, or 0 if none.
3810 */
3813{
3814 DIR *xldir;
3815 struct dirent *xlde;
3817
3819 while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
3820 {
3823
3824 /* Ignore files that are not XLOG segments. */
3825 if (!IsXLogFileName(xlde->d_name))
3826 continue;
3827
3828 /* Parse filename to get TLI and segno. */
3831
3832 /* Ignore anything that's not from the TLI of interest. */
3833 if (tli != file_tli)
3834 continue;
3835
3836 /* If it's the oldest so far, update oldest_segno. */
3837 if (oldest_segno == 0 || file_segno < oldest_segno)
3839 }
3840
3841 FreeDir(xldir);
3842 return oldest_segno;
3843}
3844
3845/*
3846 * Update the last removed segno pointer in shared memory, to reflect that the
3847 * given XLOG file has been removed.
3848 */
3849static void
3851{
3852 uint32 tli;
3853 XLogSegNo segno;
3854
3856
3858 if (segno > XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo)
3859 XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo = segno;
3861}
3862
3863/*
3864 * Remove all temporary log files in pg_wal
3865 *
3866 * This is called at the beginning of recovery after a previous crash,
3867 * at a point where no other processes write fresh WAL data.
3868 */
3869static void
3871{
3872 DIR *xldir;
3873 struct dirent *xlde;
3874
3875 elog(DEBUG2, "removing all temporary WAL segments");
3876
3878 while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
3879 {
3880 char path[MAXPGPATH];
3881
3882 if (strncmp(xlde->d_name, "xlogtemp.", 9) != 0)
3883 continue;
3884
3885 snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/%s", xlde->d_name);
3886 unlink(path);
3887 elog(DEBUG2, "removed temporary WAL segment \"%s\"", path);
3888 }
3889 FreeDir(xldir);
3890}
3891
3892/*
3893 * Recycle or remove all log files older or equal to passed segno.
3894 *
3895 * endptr is current (or recent) end of xlog, and lastredoptr is the
3896 * redo pointer of the last checkpoint. These are used to determine
3897 * whether we want to recycle rather than delete no-longer-wanted log files.
3898 *
3899 * insertTLI is the current timeline for XLOG insertion. Any recycled
3900 * segments should be reused for this timeline.
3901 */
3902static void
3905{
3906 DIR *xldir;
3907 struct dirent *xlde;
3908 char lastoff[MAXFNAMELEN];
3911
3912 /* Initialize info about where to try to recycle to */
3915
3916 /*
3917 * Construct a filename of the last segment to be kept. The timeline ID
3918 * doesn't matter, we ignore that in the comparison. (During recovery,
3919 * InsertTimeLineID isn't set, so we can't use that.)
3920 */
3922
3923 elog(DEBUG2, "attempting to remove WAL segments older than log file %s",
3924 lastoff);
3925
3927
3928 while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
3929 {
3930 /* Ignore files that are not XLOG segments */
3931 if (!IsXLogFileName(xlde->d_name) &&
3932 !IsPartialXLogFileName(xlde->d_name))
3933 continue;
3934
3935 /*
3936 * We ignore the timeline part of the XLOG segment identifiers in
3937 * deciding whether a segment is still needed. This ensures that we
3938 * won't prematurely remove a segment from a parent timeline. We could
3939 * probably be a little more proactive about removing segments of
3940 * non-parent timelines, but that would be a whole lot more
3941 * complicated.
3942 *
3943 * We use the alphanumeric sorting property of the filenames to decide
3944 * which ones are earlier than the lastoff segment.
3945 */
3946 if (strcmp(xlde->d_name + 8, lastoff + 8) <= 0)
3947 {
3948 if (XLogArchiveCheckDone(xlde->d_name))
3949 {
3950 /* Update the last removed location in shared memory first */
3951 UpdateLastRemovedPtr(xlde->d_name);
3952
3954 }
3955 }
3956 }
3957
3958 FreeDir(xldir);
3959}
3960
3961/*
3962 * Recycle or remove WAL files that are not part of the given timeline's
3963 * history.
3964 *
3965 * This is called during recovery, whenever we switch to follow a new
3966 * timeline, and at the end of recovery when we create a new timeline. We
3967 * wouldn't otherwise care about extra WAL files lying in pg_wal, but they
3968 * might be leftover pre-allocated or recycled WAL segments on the old timeline
3969 * that we haven't used yet, and contain garbage. If we just leave them in
3970 * pg_wal, they will eventually be archived, and we can't let that happen.
3971 * Files that belong to our timeline history are valid, because we have
3972 * successfully replayed them, but from others we can't be sure.
3973 *
3974 * 'switchpoint' is the current point in WAL where we switch to new timeline,
3975 * and 'newTLI' is the new timeline we switch to.
3976 */
3977void
3979{
3980 DIR *xldir;
3981 struct dirent *xlde;
3982 char switchseg[MAXFNAMELEN];
3986
3987 /*
3988 * Initialize info about where to begin the work. This will recycle,
3989 * somewhat arbitrarily, 10 future segments.
3990 */
3994
3995 /*
3996 * Construct a filename of the last segment to be kept.
3997 */
3999
4000 elog(DEBUG2, "attempting to remove WAL segments newer than log file %s",
4001 switchseg);
4002
4004
4005 while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
4006 {
4007 /* Ignore files that are not XLOG segments */
4008 if (!IsXLogFileName(xlde->d_name))
4009 continue;
4010
4011 /*
4012 * Remove files that are on a timeline older than the new one we're
4013 * switching to, but with a segment number >= the first segment on the
4014 * new timeline.
4015 */
4016 if (strncmp(xlde->d_name, switchseg, 8) < 0 &&
4017 strcmp(xlde->d_name + 8, switchseg + 8) > 0)
4018 {
4019 /*
4020 * If the file has already been marked as .ready, however, don't
4021 * remove it yet. It should be OK to remove it - files that are
4022 * not part of our timeline history are not required for recovery
4023 * - but seems safer to let them be archived and removed later.
4024 */
4025 if (!XLogArchiveIsReady(xlde->d_name))
4027 }
4028 }
4029
4030 FreeDir(xldir);
4031}
4032
4033/*
4034 * Recycle or remove a log file that's no longer needed.
4035 *
4036 * segment_de is the dirent structure of the segment to recycle or remove.
4037 * recycleSegNo is the segment number to recycle up to. endlogSegNo is
4038 * the segment number of the current (or recent) end of WAL.
4039 *
4040 * endlogSegNo gets incremented if the segment is recycled so as it is not
4041 * checked again with future callers of this function.
4042 *
4043 * insertTLI is the current timeline for XLOG insertion. Any recycled segments
4044 * should be used for this timeline.
4045 */
4046static void
4050{
4051 char path[MAXPGPATH];
4052#ifdef WIN32
4053 char newpath[MAXPGPATH];
4054#endif
4055 const char *segname = segment_de->d_name;
4056
4057 snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/%s", segname);
4058
4059 /*
4060 * Before deleting the file, see if it can be recycled as a future log
4061 * segment. Only recycle normal files, because we don't want to recycle
4062 * symbolic links pointing to a separate archive directory.
4063 */
4064 if (wal_recycle &&
4066 XLogCtl->InstallXLogFileSegmentActive && /* callee rechecks this */
4067 get_dirent_type(path, segment_de, false, DEBUG2) == PGFILETYPE_REG &&
4069 true, recycleSegNo, insertTLI))
4070 {
4072 (errmsg_internal("recycled write-ahead log file \"%s\"",
4073 segname)));
4075 /* Needn't recheck that slot on future iterations */
4076 (*endlogSegNo)++;
4077 }
4078 else
4079 {
4080 /* No need for any more future segments, or recycling failed ... */
4081 int rc;
4082
4084 (errmsg_internal("removing write-ahead log file \"%s\"",
4085 segname)));
4086
4087#ifdef WIN32
4088
4089 /*
4090 * On Windows, if another process (e.g another backend) holds the file
4091 * open in FILE_SHARE_DELETE mode, unlink will succeed, but the file
4092 * will still show up in directory listing until the last handle is
4093 * closed. To avoid confusing the lingering deleted file for a live
4094 * WAL file that needs to be archived, rename it before deleting it.
4095 *
4096 * If another process holds the file open without FILE_SHARE_DELETE
4097 * flag, rename will fail. We'll try again at the next checkpoint.
4098 */
4099 snprintf(newpath, MAXPGPATH, "%s.deleted", path);
4100 if (rename(path, newpath) != 0)
4101 {
4102 ereport(LOG,
4104 errmsg("could not rename file \"%s\": %m",
4105 path)));
4106 return;
4107 }
4108 rc = durable_unlink(newpath, LOG);
4109#else
4110 rc = durable_unlink(path, LOG);
4111#endif
4112 if (rc != 0)
4113 {
4114 /* Message already logged by durable_unlink() */
4115 return;
4116 }
4118 }
4119
4121}
4122
4123/*
4124 * Verify whether pg_wal, pg_wal/archive_status, and pg_wal/summaries exist.
4125 * If the latter do not exist, recreate them.
4126 *
4127 * It is not the goal of this function to verify the contents of these
4128 * directories, but to help in cases where someone has performed a cluster
4129 * copy for PITR purposes but omitted pg_wal from the copy.
4130 *
4131 * We could also recreate pg_wal if it doesn't exist, but a deliberate
4132 * policy decision was made not to. It is fairly common for pg_wal to be
4133 * a symlink, and if that was the DBA's intent then automatically making a
4134 * plain directory would result in degraded performance with no notice.
4135 */
4136static void
4138{
4139 char path[MAXPGPATH];
4140 struct stat stat_buf;
4141
4142 /* Check for pg_wal; if it doesn't exist, error out */
4143 if (stat(XLOGDIR, &stat_buf) != 0 ||
4144 !S_ISDIR(stat_buf.st_mode))
4145 ereport(FATAL,
4147 errmsg("required WAL directory \"%s\" does not exist",
4148 XLOGDIR)));
4149
4150 /* Check for archive_status */
4151 snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/archive_status");
4152 if (stat(path, &stat_buf) == 0)
4153 {
4154 /* Check for weird cases where it exists but isn't a directory */
4155 if (!S_ISDIR(stat_buf.st_mode))
4156 ereport(FATAL,
4158 errmsg("required WAL directory \"%s\" does not exist",
4159 path)));
4160 }
4161 else
4162 {
4163 ereport(LOG,
4164 (errmsg("creating missing WAL directory \"%s\"", path)));
4165 if (MakePGDirectory(path) < 0)
4166 ereport(FATAL,
4168 errmsg("could not create missing directory \"%s\": %m",
4169 path)));
4170 }
4171
4172 /* Check for summaries */
4173 snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/summaries");
4174 if (stat(path, &stat_buf) == 0)
4175 {
4176 /* Check for weird cases where it exists but isn't a directory */
4177 if (!S_ISDIR(stat_buf.st_mode))
4178 ereport(FATAL,
4179 (errmsg("required WAL directory \"%s\" does not exist",
4180 path)));
4181 }
4182 else
4183 {
4184 ereport(LOG,
4185 (errmsg("creating missing WAL directory \"%s\"", path)));
4186 if (MakePGDirectory(path) < 0)
4187 ereport(FATAL,
4188 (errmsg("could not create missing directory \"%s\": %m",
4189 path)));
4190 }
4191}
4192
4193/*
4194 * Remove previous backup history files. This also retries creation of
4195 * .ready files for any backup history files for which XLogArchiveNotify
4196 * failed earlier.
4197 */
4198static void
4200{
4201 DIR *xldir;
4202 struct dirent *xlde;
4203 char path[MAXPGPATH + sizeof(XLOGDIR)];
4204
4206
4207 while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
4208 {
4209 if (IsBackupHistoryFileName(xlde->d_name))
4210 {
4211 if (XLogArchiveCheckDone(xlde->d_name))
4212 {
4213 elog(DEBUG2, "removing WAL backup history file \"%s\"",
4214 xlde->d_name);
4215 snprintf(path, sizeof(path), XLOGDIR "/%s", xlde->d_name);
4216 unlink(path);
4217 XLogArchiveCleanup(xlde->d_name);
4218 }
4219 }
4220 }
4221
4222 FreeDir(xldir);
4223}
4224
4225/*
4226 * I/O routines for pg_control
4227 *
4228 * *ControlFile is a buffer in shared memory that holds an image of the
4229 * contents of pg_control. WriteControlFile() initializes pg_control
4230 * given a preloaded buffer, ReadControlFile() loads the buffer from
4231 * the pg_control file (during postmaster or standalone-backend startup),
4232 * and UpdateControlFile() rewrites pg_control after we modify xlog state.
4233 * InitControlFile() fills the buffer with initial values.
4234 *
4235 * For simplicity, WriteControlFile() initializes the fields of pg_control
4236 * that are related to checking backend/database compatibility, and
4237 * ReadControlFile() verifies they are correct. We could split out the
4238 * I/O and compatibility-check functions, but there seems no need currently.
4239 */
4240
4241static void
4242InitControlFile(uint64 sysidentifier, uint32 data_checksum_version)
4243{
4245
4246 /*
4247 * Generate a random nonce. This is used for authentication requests that
4248 * will fail because the user does not exist. The nonce is used to create
4249 * a genuine-looking password challenge for the non-existent user, in lieu
4250 * of an actual stored password.
4251 */
4253 ereport(PANIC,
4255 errmsg("could not generate secret authorization token")));
4256
4257 memset(ControlFile, 0, sizeof(ControlFileData));
4258 /* Initialize pg_control status fields */
4259 ControlFile->system_identifier = sysidentifier;
4263
4264 /* Set important parameter values for use when replaying WAL */
4273 ControlFile->data_checksum_version = data_checksum_version;
4274}
4275
4276static void
4278{
4279 int fd;
4280 char buffer[PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE]; /* need not be aligned */
4281
4282 /*
4283 * Initialize version and compatibility-check fields
4284 */
4287
4290
4296
4299
4302
4303 ControlFile->float8ByVal = true; /* vestigial */
4304
4305 /*
4306 * Initialize the default 'char' signedness.
4307 *
4308 * The signedness of the char type is implementation-defined. For instance
4309 * on x86 architecture CPUs, the char data type is typically treated as
4310 * signed by default, whereas on aarch architecture CPUs, it is typically
4311 * treated as unsigned by default. In v17 or earlier, we accidentally let
4312 * C implementation signedness affect persistent data. This led to
4313 * inconsistent results when comparing char data across different
4314 * platforms.
4315 *
4316 * This flag can be used as a hint to ensure consistent behavior for
4317 * pre-v18 data files that store data sorted by the 'char' type on disk,
4318 * especially in cross-platform replication scenarios.
4319 *
4320 * Newly created database clusters unconditionally set the default char
4321 * signedness to true. pg_upgrade changes this flag for clusters that were
4322 * initialized on signedness=false platforms. As a result,
4323 * signedness=false setting will become rare over time. If we had known
4324 * about this problem during the last development cycle that forced initdb
4325 * (v8.3), we would have made all clusters signed or all clusters
4326 * unsigned. Making pg_upgrade the only source of signedness=false will
4327 * cause the population of database clusters to converge toward that
4328 * retrospective ideal.
4329 */
4331
4332 /* Contents are protected with a CRC */
4338
4339 /*
4340 * We write out PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE bytes into pg_control, zero-padding
4341 * the excess over sizeof(ControlFileData). This reduces the odds of
4342 * premature-EOF errors when reading pg_control. We'll still fail when we
4343 * check the contents of the file, but hopefully with a more specific
4344 * error than "couldn't read pg_control".
4345 */
4346 memset(buffer, 0, PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE);
4347 memcpy(buffer, ControlFile, sizeof(ControlFileData));
4348
4351 if (fd < 0)
4352 ereport(PANIC,
4354 errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m",
4356
4357 errno = 0;
4360 {
4361 /* if write didn't set errno, assume problem is no disk space */
4362 if (errno == 0)
4363 errno = ENOSPC;
4364 ereport(PANIC,
4366 errmsg("could not write to file \"%s\": %m",
4368 }
4370
4372 if (pg_fsync(fd) != 0)
4373 ereport(PANIC,
4375 errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m",
4378
4379 if (close(fd) != 0)
4380 ereport(PANIC,
4382 errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m",
4384}
4385
4386static void
4388{
4389 pg_crc32c crc;
4390 int fd;
4391 char wal_segsz_str[20];
4392 int r;
4393
4394 /*
4395 * Read data...
4396 */
4398 O_RDWR | PG_BINARY);
4399 if (fd < 0)
4400 ereport(PANIC,
4402 errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m",
4404
4406 r = read(fd, ControlFile, sizeof(ControlFileData));
4407 if (r != sizeof(ControlFileData))
4408 {
4409 if (r < 0)
4410 ereport(PANIC,
4412 errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": %m",
4414 else
4415 ereport(PANIC,
4417 errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": read %d of %zu",
4418 XLOG_CONTROL_FILE, r, sizeof(ControlFileData))));
4419 }
4421
4422 close(fd);
4423
4424 /*
4425 * Check for expected pg_control format version. If this is wrong, the
4426 * CRC check will likely fail because we'll be checking the wrong number
4427 * of bytes. Complaining about wrong version will probably be more
4428 * enlightening than complaining about wrong CRC.
4429 */
4430
4432 ereport(FATAL,
4434 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4435 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d (0x%08x),"
4436 " but the server was compiled with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d (0x%08x).",
4439 errhint("This could be a problem of mismatched byte ordering. It looks like you need to initdb.")));
4440
4442 ereport(FATAL,
4444 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4445 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d,"
4446 " but the server was compiled with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d.",
4448 errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
4449
4450 /* Now check the CRC. */
4455 FIN_CRC32C(crc);
4456
4457 if (!EQ_CRC32C(crc, ControlFile->crc))
4458 ereport(FATAL,
4460 errmsg("incorrect checksum in control file")));
4461
4462 /*
4463 * Do compatibility checking immediately. If the database isn't
4464 * compatible with the backend executable, we want to abort before we can
4465 * possibly do any damage.
4466 */
4468 ereport(FATAL,
4470 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4471 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4472 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4473 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4474 "CATALOG_VERSION_NO", ControlFile->catalog_version_no,
4475 "CATALOG_VERSION_NO", CATALOG_VERSION_NO),
4476 errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
4478 ereport(FATAL,
4480 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4481 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4482 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4483 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4484 "MAXALIGN", ControlFile->maxAlign,
4485 "MAXALIGN", MAXIMUM_ALIGNOF),
4486 errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
4488 ereport(FATAL,
4490 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4491 errdetail("The database cluster appears to use a different floating-point number format than the server executable."),
4492 errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
4493 if (ControlFile->blcksz != BLCKSZ)
4494 ereport(FATAL,
4496 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4497 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4498 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4499 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4500 "BLCKSZ", ControlFile->blcksz,
4501 "BLCKSZ", BLCKSZ),
4502 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4504 ereport(FATAL,
4506 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4507 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4508 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4509 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4510 "RELSEG_SIZE", ControlFile->relseg_size,
4511 "RELSEG_SIZE", RELSEG_SIZE),
4512 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4514 ereport(FATAL,
4516 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4517 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4518 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4519 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4520 "SLRU_PAGES_PER_SEGMENT", ControlFile->slru_pages_per_segment,
4521 "SLRU_PAGES_PER_SEGMENT", SLRU_PAGES_PER_SEGMENT),
4522 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4524 ereport(FATAL,
4526 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4527 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4528 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4529 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4530 "XLOG_BLCKSZ", ControlFile->xlog_blcksz,
4531 "XLOG_BLCKSZ", XLOG_BLCKSZ),
4532 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4534 ereport(FATAL,
4536 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4537 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4538 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4539 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4540 "NAMEDATALEN", ControlFile->nameDataLen,
4541 "NAMEDATALEN", NAMEDATALEN),
4542 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4544 ereport(FATAL,
4546 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4547 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4548 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4549 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4550 "INDEX_MAX_KEYS", ControlFile->indexMaxKeys,
4551 "INDEX_MAX_KEYS", INDEX_MAX_KEYS),
4552 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4554 ereport(FATAL,
4556 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4557 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4558 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4559 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4560 "TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE", ControlFile->toast_max_chunk_size,
4561 "TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE", (int) TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE),
4562 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4564 ereport(FATAL,
4566 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4567 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4568 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4569 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4570 "LOBLKSIZE", ControlFile->loblksize,
4571 "LOBLKSIZE", (int) LOBLKSIZE),
4572 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4573
4574 Assert(ControlFile->float8ByVal); /* vestigial, not worth an error msg */
4575
4577
4580 errmsg_plural("invalid WAL segment size in control file (%d byte)",
4581 "invalid WAL segment size in control file (%d bytes)",
4584 errdetail("The WAL segment size must be a power of two between 1 MB and 1 GB.")));
4585
4587 SetConfigOption("wal_segment_size", wal_segsz_str, PGC_INTERNAL,
4589
4590 /* check and update variables dependent on wal_segment_size */
4593 /* translator: both %s are GUC names */
4594 errmsg("\"%s\" must be at least twice \"%s\"",
4595 "min_wal_size", "wal_segment_size")));
4596
4599 /* translator: both %s are GUC names */
4600 errmsg("\"%s\" must be at least twice \"%s\"",
4601 "max_wal_size", "wal_segment_size")));
4602
4606
4608
4609 /* Make the initdb settings visible as GUC variables, too */
4610 SetConfigOption("data_checksums", DataChecksumsEnabled() ? "yes" : "no",
4612}
4613
4614/*
4615 * Utility wrapper to update the control file. Note that the control
4616 * file gets flushed.
4617 */
4618static void
4623
4624/*
4625 * Returns the unique system identifier from control file.
4626 */
4627uint64
4633
4634/*
4635 * Returns the random nonce from control file.
4636 */
4637char *
4643
4644/*
4645 * Are checksums enabled for data pages?
4646 */
4647bool
4649{
4651 return (ControlFile->data_checksum_version > 0);
4652}
4653
4654/*
4655 * Return true if the cluster was initialized on a platform where the
4656 * default signedness of char is "signed". This function exists for code
4657 * that deals with pre-v18 data files that store data sorted by the 'char'
4658 * type on disk (e.g., GIN and GiST indexes). See the comments in
4659 * WriteControlFile() for details.
4660 */
4661bool
4666
4667/*
4668 * Returns a fake LSN for unlogged relations.
4669 *
4670 * Each call generates an LSN that is greater than any previous value
4671 * returned. The current counter value is saved and restored across clean
4672 * shutdowns, but like unlogged relations, does not survive a crash. This can
4673 * be used in lieu of real LSN values returned by XLogInsert, if you need an
4674 * LSN-like increasing sequence of numbers without writing any WAL.
4675 */
4681
4682/*
4683 * Auto-tune the number of XLOG buffers.
4684 *
4685 * The preferred setting for wal_buffers is about 3% of shared_buffers, with
4686 * a maximum of one XLOG segment (there is little reason to think that more
4687 * is helpful, at least so long as we force an fsync when switching log files)
4688 * and a minimum of 8 blocks (which was the default value prior to PostgreSQL
4689 * 9.1, when auto-tuning was added).
4690 *
4691 * This should not be called until NBuffers has received its final value.
4692 */
4693static int
4695{
4696 int xbuffers;
4697
4698 xbuffers = NBuffers / 32;
4701 if (xbuffers < 8)
4702 xbuffers = 8;
4703 return xbuffers;
4704}
4705
4706/*
4707 * GUC check_hook for wal_buffers
4708 */
4709bool
4711{
4712 /*
4713 * -1 indicates a request for auto-tune.
4714 */
4715 if (*newval == -1)
4716 {
4717 /*
4718 * If we haven't yet changed the boot_val default of -1, just let it
4719 * be. We'll fix it when XLOGShmemSize is called.
4720 */
4721 if (XLOGbuffers == -1)
4722 return true;
4723
4724 /* Otherwise, substitute the auto-tune value */
4726 }
4727
4728 /*
4729 * We clamp manually-set values to at least 4 blocks. Prior to PostgreSQL
4730 * 9.1, a minimum of 4 was enforced by guc.c, but since that is no longer
4731 * the case, we just silently treat such values as a request for the
4732 * minimum. (We could throw an error instead, but that doesn't seem very
4733 * helpful.)
4734 */
4735 if (*newval < 4)
4736 *newval = 4;
4737
4738 return true;
4739}
4740
4741/*
4742 * GUC check_hook for wal_consistency_checking
4743 */
4744bool
4746{
4747 char *rawstring;
4748 List *elemlist;
4749 ListCell *l;
4750 bool newwalconsistency[RM_MAX_ID + 1];
4751
4752 /* Initialize the array */
4753 MemSet(newwalconsistency, 0, (RM_MAX_ID + 1) * sizeof(bool));
4754
4755 /* Need a modifiable copy of string */
4757
4758 /* Parse string into list of identifiers */
4760 {
4761 /* syntax error in list */
4762 GUC_check_errdetail("List syntax is invalid.");
4765 return false;
4766 }
4767
4768 foreach(l, elemlist)
4769 {
4770 char *tok = (char *) lfirst(l);
4771 int rmid;
4772
4773 /* Check for 'all'. */
4774 if (pg_strcasecmp(tok, "all") == 0)
4775 {
4776 for (rmid = 0; rmid <= RM_MAX_ID; rmid++)
4777 if (RmgrIdExists(rmid) && GetRmgr(rmid).rm_mask != NULL)
4778 newwalconsistency[rmid] = true;
4779 }
4780 else
4781 {
4782 /* Check if the token matches any known resource manager. */
4783 bool found = false;
4784
4785 for (rmid = 0; rmid <= RM_MAX_ID; rmid++)
4786 {
4787 if (RmgrIdExists(rmid) && GetRmgr(rmid).rm_mask != NULL &&
4788 pg_strcasecmp(tok, GetRmgr(rmid).rm_name) == 0)
4789 {
4790 newwalconsistency[rmid] = true;
4791 found = true;
4792 break;
4793 }
4794 }
4795 if (!found)
4796 {
4797 /*
4798 * During startup, it might be a not-yet-loaded custom
4799 * resource manager. Defer checking until
4800 * InitializeWalConsistencyChecking().
4801 */
4803 {
4805 }
4806 else
4807 {
4808 GUC_check_errdetail("Unrecognized key word: \"%s\".", tok);
4811 return false;
4812 }
4813 }
4814 }
4815 }
4816
4819
4820 /* assign new value */
4821 *extra = guc_malloc(LOG, (RM_MAX_ID + 1) * sizeof(bool));
4822 if (!*extra)
4823 return false;
4824 memcpy(*extra, newwalconsistency, (RM_MAX_ID + 1) * sizeof(bool));
4825 return true;
4826}
4827
4828/*
4829 * GUC assign_hook for wal_consistency_checking
4830 */
4831void
4833{
4834 /*
4835 * If some checks were deferred, it's possible that the checks will fail
4836 * later during InitializeWalConsistencyChecking(). But in that case, the
4837 * postmaster will exit anyway, so it's safe to proceed with the
4838 * assignment.
4839 *
4840 * Any built-in resource managers specified are assigned immediately,
4841 * which affects WAL created before shared_preload_libraries are
4842 * processed. Any custom resource managers specified won't be assigned
4843 * until after shared_preload_libraries are processed, but that's OK
4844 * because WAL for a custom resource manager can't be written before the
4845 * module is loaded anyway.
4846 */
4848}
4849
4850/*
4851 * InitializeWalConsistencyChecking: run after loading custom resource managers
4852 *
4853 * If any unknown resource managers were specified in the
4854 * wal_consistency_checking GUC, processing was deferred. Now that
4855 * shared_preload_libraries have been loaded, process wal_consistency_checking
4856 * again.
4857 */
4858void
4860{
4862
4864 {
4865 struct config_generic *guc;
4866
4867 guc = find_option("wal_consistency_checking", false, false, ERROR);
4868
4870
4871 set_config_option_ext("wal_consistency_checking",
4873 guc->scontext, guc->source, guc->srole,
4874 GUC_ACTION_SET, true, ERROR, false);
4875
4876 /* checking should not be deferred again */
4878 }
4879}
4880
4881/*
4882 * GUC show_hook for archive_command
4883 */
4884const char *
4886{
4887 if (XLogArchivingActive())
4888 return XLogArchiveCommand;
4889 else
4890 return "(disabled)";
4891}
4892
4893/*
4894 * GUC show_hook for in_hot_standby
4895 */
4896const char *
4898{
4899 /*
4900 * We display the actual state based on shared memory, so that this GUC
4901 * reports up-to-date state if examined intra-query. The underlying
4902 * variable (in_hot_standby_guc) changes only when we transmit a new value
4903 * to the client.
4904 */
4905 return RecoveryInProgress() ? "on" : "off";
4906}
4907
4908/*
4909 * GUC show_hook for effective_wal_level
4910 */
4911const char *
4913{
4915 return "minimal";
4916
4917 /*
4918 * During recovery, effective_wal_level reflects the primary's
4919 * configuration rather than the local wal_level value.
4920 */
4921 if (RecoveryInProgress())
4922 return IsXLogLogicalInfoEnabled() ? "logical" : "replica";
4923
4924 return XLogLogicalInfoActive() ? "logical" : "replica";
4925}
4926
4927/*
4928 * Read the control file, set respective GUCs.
4929 *
4930 * This is to be called during startup, including a crash recovery cycle,
4931 * unless in bootstrap mode, where no control file yet exists. As there's no
4932 * usable shared memory yet (its sizing can depend on the contents of the
4933 * control file!), first store the contents in local memory. XLOGShmemInit()
4934 * will then copy it to shared memory later.
4935 *
4936 * reset just controls whether previous contents are to be expected (in the
4937 * reset case, there's a dangling pointer into old shared memory), or not.
4938 */
4939void
4946
4947/*
4948 * Get the wal_level from the control file. For a standby, this value should be
4949 * considered as its active wal_level, because it may be different from what
4950 * was originally configured on standby.
4951 */
4954{
4955 return ControlFile->wal_level;
4956}
4957
4958/*
4959 * Initialization of shared memory for XLOG
4960 */
4961Size
4963{
4964 Size size;
4965
4966 /*
4967 * If the value of wal_buffers is -1, use the preferred auto-tune value.
4968 * This isn't an amazingly clean place to do this, but we must wait till
4969 * NBuffers has received its final value, and must do it before using the
4970 * value of XLOGbuffers to do anything important.
4971 *
4972 * We prefer to report this value's source as PGC_S_DYNAMIC_DEFAULT.
4973 * However, if the DBA explicitly set wal_buffers = -1 in the config file,
4974 * then PGC_S_DYNAMIC_DEFAULT will fail to override that and we must force
4975 * the matter with PGC_S_OVERRIDE.
4976 */
4977 if (XLOGbuffers == -1)
4978 {
4979 char buf[32];
4980
4981 snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf), "%d", XLOGChooseNumBuffers());
4982 SetConfigOption("wal_buffers", buf, PGC_POSTMASTER,
4984 if (XLOGbuffers == -1) /* failed to apply it? */
4985 SetConfigOption("wal_buffers", buf, PGC_POSTMASTER,
4987 }
4988 Assert(XLOGbuffers > 0);
4989
4990 /* XLogCtl */
4991 size = sizeof(XLogCtlData);
4992
4993 /* WAL insertion locks, plus alignment */
4994 size = add_size(size, mul_size(sizeof(WALInsertLockPadded), NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS + 1));
4995 /* xlblocks array */
4996 size = add_size(size, mul_size(sizeof(pg_atomic_uint64), XLOGbuffers));
4997 /* extra alignment padding for XLOG I/O buffers */
4998 size = add_size(size, Max(XLOG_BLCKSZ, PG_IO_ALIGN_SIZE));
4999 /* and the buffers themselves */
5000 size = add_size(size, mul_size(XLOG_BLCKSZ, XLOGbuffers));
5001
5002 /*
5003 * Note: we don't count ControlFileData, it comes out of the "slop factor"
5004 * added by CreateSharedMemoryAndSemaphores. This lets us use this
5005 * routine again below to compute the actual allocation size.
5006 */
5007
5008 return size;
5009}
5010
5011void
5013{
5014 bool foundCFile,
5015 foundXLog;
5016 char *allocptr;
5017 int i;
5019
5020#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
5021
5022 /*
5023 * Create a memory context for WAL debugging that's exempt from the normal
5024 * "no pallocs in critical section" rule. Yes, that can lead to a PANIC if
5025 * an allocation fails, but wal_debug is not for production use anyway.
5026 */
5027 if (walDebugCxt == NULL)
5028 {
5030 "WAL Debug",
5033 }
5034#endif
5035
5036
5037 XLogCtl = (XLogCtlData *)
5038 ShmemInitStruct("XLOG Ctl", XLOGShmemSize(), &foundXLog);
5039
5042 ShmemInitStruct("Control File", sizeof(ControlFileData), &foundCFile);
5043
5044 if (foundCFile || foundXLog)
5045 {
5046 /* both should be present or neither */
5048
5049 /* Initialize local copy of WALInsertLocks */
5051
5052 if (localControlFile)
5054 return;
5055 }
5056 memset(XLogCtl, 0, sizeof(XLogCtlData));
5057
5058 /*
5059 * Already have read control file locally, unless in bootstrap mode. Move
5060 * contents into shared memory.
5061 */
5062 if (localControlFile)
5063 {
5066 }
5067
5068 /*
5069 * Since XLogCtlData contains XLogRecPtr fields, its sizeof should be a
5070 * multiple of the alignment for same, so no extra alignment padding is
5071 * needed here.
5072 */
5073 allocptr = ((char *) XLogCtl) + sizeof(XLogCtlData);
5076
5077 for (i = 0; i < XLOGbuffers; i++)
5078 {
5080 }
5081
5082 /* WAL insertion locks. Ensure they're aligned to the full padded size */
5083 allocptr += sizeof(WALInsertLockPadded) -
5088
5089 for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
5090 {
5094 }
5095
5096 /*
5097 * Align the start of the page buffers to a full xlog block size boundary.
5098 * This simplifies some calculations in XLOG insertion. It is also
5099 * required for O_DIRECT.
5100 */
5104
5105 /*
5106 * Do basic initialization of XLogCtl shared data. (StartupXLOG will fill
5107 * in additional info.)
5108 */
5112 XLogCtl->WalWriterSleeping = false;
5113
5120}
5121
5122/*
5123 * This func must be called ONCE on system install. It creates pg_control
5124 * and the initial XLOG segment.
5125 */
5126void
5127BootStrapXLOG(uint32 data_checksum_version)
5128{
5129 CheckPoint checkPoint;
5130 PGAlignedXLogBlock buffer;
5131 XLogPageHeader page;
5133 XLogRecord *record;
5134 char *recptr;
5135 uint64 sysidentifier;
5136 struct timeval tv;
5137 pg_crc32c crc;
5138
5139 /* allow ordinary WAL segment creation, like StartupXLOG() would */
5141
5142 /*
5143 * Select a hopefully-unique system identifier code for this installation.
5144 * We use the result of gettimeofday(), including the fractional seconds
5145 * field, as being about as unique as we can easily get. (Think not to
5146 * use random(), since it hasn't been seeded and there's no portable way
5147 * to seed it other than the system clock value...) The upper half of the
5148 * uint64 value is just the tv_sec part, while the lower half contains the
5149 * tv_usec part (which must fit in 20 bits), plus 12 bits from our current
5150 * PID for a little extra uniqueness. A person knowing this encoding can
5151 * determine the initialization time of the installation, which could
5152 * perhaps be useful sometimes.
5153 */
5154 gettimeofday(&tv, NULL);
5155 sysidentifier = ((uint64) tv.tv_sec) << 32;
5156 sysidentifier |= ((uint64) tv.tv_usec) << 12;
5157 sysidentifier |= getpid() & 0xFFF;
5158
5159 memset(&buffer, 0, sizeof buffer);
5160 page = (XLogPageHeader) &buffer;
5161
5162 /*
5163 * Set up information for the initial checkpoint record
5164 *
5165 * The initial checkpoint record is written to the beginning of the WAL
5166 * segment with logid=0 logseg=1. The very first WAL segment, 0/0, is not
5167 * used, so that we can use 0/0 to mean "before any valid WAL segment".
5168 */
5172 checkPoint.fullPageWrites = fullPageWrites;
5174 checkPoint.wal_level = wal_level;
5175 checkPoint.nextXid =
5177 checkPoint.nextOid = FirstGenbkiObjectId;
5178 checkPoint.nextMulti = FirstMultiXactId;
5179 checkPoint.nextMultiOffset = 1;
5181 checkPoint.oldestXidDB = Template1DbOid;
5182 checkPoint.oldestMulti = FirstMultiXactId;
5183 checkPoint.oldestMultiDB = Template1DbOid;
5186 checkPoint.time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
5188
5189 TransamVariables->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
5190 TransamVariables->nextOid = checkPoint.nextOid;
5192 MultiXactSetNextMXact(checkPoint.nextMulti, checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
5193 AdvanceOldestClogXid(checkPoint.oldestXid);
5194 SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid, checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
5195 SetMultiXactIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestMulti, checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
5197
5198 /* Set up the XLOG page header */
5199 page->xlp_magic = XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC;
5200 page->xlp_info = XLP_LONG_HEADER;
5204 longpage->xlp_sysid = sysidentifier;
5205 longpage->xlp_seg_size = wal_segment_size;
5206 longpage->xlp_xlog_blcksz = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
5207
5208 /* Insert the initial checkpoint record */
5209 recptr = ((char *) page + SizeOfXLogLongPHD);
5210 record = (XLogRecord *) recptr;
5211 record->xl_prev = 0;
5212 record->xl_xid = InvalidTransactionId;
5213 record->xl_tot_len = SizeOfXLogRecord + SizeOfXLogRecordDataHeaderShort + sizeof(checkPoint);
5215 record->xl_rmid = RM_XLOG_ID;
5217 /* fill the XLogRecordDataHeaderShort struct */
5218 *(recptr++) = (char) XLR_BLOCK_ID_DATA_SHORT;
5219 *(recptr++) = sizeof(checkPoint);
5220 memcpy(recptr, &checkPoint, sizeof(checkPoint));
5221 recptr += sizeof(checkPoint);
5222 Assert(recptr - (char *) record == record->xl_tot_len);
5223
5225 COMP_CRC32C(crc, ((char *) record) + SizeOfXLogRecord, record->xl_tot_len - SizeOfXLogRecord);
5226 COMP_CRC32C(crc, (char *) record, offsetof(XLogRecord, xl_crc));
5227 FIN_CRC32C(crc);
5228 record->xl_crc = crc;
5229
5230 /* Create first XLOG segment file */
5233
5234 /*
5235 * We needn't bother with Reserve/ReleaseExternalFD here, since we'll
5236 * close the file again in a moment.
5237 */
5238
5239 /* Write the first page with the initial record */
5240 errno = 0;
5242 if (write(openLogFile, &buffer, XLOG_BLCKSZ) != XLOG_BLCKSZ)
5243 {
5244 /* if write didn't set errno, assume problem is no disk space */
5245 if (errno == 0)
5246 errno = ENOSPC;
5247 ereport(PANIC,
5249 errmsg("could not write bootstrap write-ahead log file: %m")));
5250 }
5252
5254 if (pg_fsync(openLogFile) != 0)
5255 ereport(PANIC,
5257 errmsg("could not fsync bootstrap write-ahead log file: %m")));
5259
5260 if (close(openLogFile) != 0)
5261 ereport(PANIC,
5263 errmsg("could not close bootstrap write-ahead log file: %m")));
5264
5265 openLogFile = -1;
5266
5267 /* Now create pg_control */
5268 InitControlFile(sysidentifier, data_checksum_version);
5269 ControlFile->time = checkPoint.time;
5270 ControlFile->checkPoint = checkPoint.redo;
5271 ControlFile->checkPointCopy = checkPoint;
5272
5273 /* some additional ControlFile fields are set in WriteControlFile() */
5275
5276 /* Bootstrap the commit log, too */
5277 BootStrapCLOG();
5281
5282 /*
5283 * Force control file to be read - in contrast to normal processing we'd
5284 * otherwise never run the checks and GUC related initializations therein.
5285 */
5287}
5288
5289static char *
5291{
5293 "%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S %Z",
5295
5296 return buf;
5297}
5298
5299/*
5300 * Initialize the first WAL segment on new timeline.
5301 */
5302static void
5304{
5305 char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
5308
5309 /* we always switch to a new timeline after archive recovery */
5310 Assert(endTLI != newTLI);
5311
5312 /*
5313 * Update min recovery point one last time.
5314 */
5316
5317 /*
5318 * Calculate the last segment on the old timeline, and the first segment
5319 * on the new timeline. If the switch happens in the middle of a segment,
5320 * they are the same, but if the switch happens exactly at a segment
5321 * boundary, startLogSegNo will be endLogSegNo + 1.
5322 */
5325
5326 /*
5327 * Initialize the starting WAL segment for the new timeline. If the switch
5328 * happens in the middle of a segment, copy data from the last WAL segment
5329 * of the old timeline up to the switch point, to the starting WAL segment
5330 * on the new timeline.
5331 */
5333 {
5334 /*
5335 * Make a copy of the file on the new timeline.
5336 *
5337 * Writing WAL isn't allowed yet, so there are no locking
5338 * considerations. But we should be just as tense as XLogFileInit to
5339 * avoid emplacing a bogus file.
5340 */
5343 }
5344 else
5345 {
5346 /*
5347 * The switch happened at a segment boundary, so just create the next
5348 * segment on the new timeline.
5349 */
5350 int fd;
5351
5353
5354 if (close(fd) != 0)
5355 {
5356 int save_errno = errno;
5357
5359 errno = save_errno;
5360 ereport(ERROR,
5362 errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", xlogfname)));
5363 }
5364 }
5365
5366 /*
5367 * Let's just make real sure there are not .ready or .done flags posted
5368 * for the new segment.
5369 */
5372}
5373
5374/*
5375 * Perform cleanup actions at the conclusion of archive recovery.
5376 */
5377static void
5380{
5381 /*
5382 * Execute the recovery_end_command, if any.
5383 */
5386 "recovery_end_command",
5387 true,
5389
5390 /*
5391 * We switched to a new timeline. Clean up segments on the old timeline.
5392 *
5393 * If there are any higher-numbered segments on the old timeline, remove
5394 * them. They might contain valid WAL, but they might also be
5395 * pre-allocated files containing garbage. In any case, they are not part
5396 * of the new timeline's history so we don't need them.
5397 */
5399
5400 /*
5401 * If the switch happened in the middle of a segment, what to do with the
5402 * last, partial segment on the old timeline? If we don't archive it, and
5403 * the server that created the WAL never archives it either (e.g. because
5404 * it was hit by a meteor), it will never make it to the archive. That's
5405 * OK from our point of view, because the new segment that we created with
5406 * the new TLI contains all the WAL from the old timeline up to the switch
5407 * point. But if you later try to do PITR to the "missing" WAL on the old
5408 * timeline, recovery won't find it in the archive. It's physically
5409 * present in the new file with new TLI, but recovery won't look there
5410 * when it's recovering to the older timeline. On the other hand, if we
5411 * archive the partial segment, and the original server on that timeline
5412 * is still running and archives the completed version of the same segment
5413 * later, it will fail. (We used to do that in 9.4 and below, and it
5414 * caused such problems).
5415 *
5416 * As a compromise, we rename the last segment with the .partial suffix,
5417 * and archive it. Archive recovery will never try to read .partial
5418 * segments, so they will normally go unused. But in the odd PITR case,
5419 * the administrator can copy them manually to the pg_wal directory
5420 * (removing the suffix). They can be useful in debugging, too.
5421 *
5422 * If a .done or .ready file already exists for the old timeline, however,
5423 * we had already determined that the segment is complete, so we can let
5424 * it be archived normally. (In particular, if it was restored from the
5425 * archive to begin with, it's expected to have a .done file).
5426 */
5429 {
5430 char origfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
5432
5435
5437 {
5438 char origpath[MAXPGPATH];
5440 char partialpath[MAXPGPATH];
5441
5442 /*
5443 * If we're summarizing WAL, we can't rename the partial file
5444 * until the summarizer finishes with it, else it will fail.
5445 */
5446 if (summarize_wal)
5448
5450 snprintf(partialfname, MAXFNAMELEN, "%s.partial", origfname);
5451 snprintf(partialpath, MAXPGPATH, "%s.partial", origpath);
5452
5453 /*
5454 * Make sure there's no .done or .ready file for the .partial
5455 * file.
5456 */
5458
5461 }
5462 }
5463}
5464
5465/*
5466 * Check to see if required parameters are set high enough on this server
5467 * for various aspects of recovery operation.
5468 *
5469 * Note that all the parameters which this function tests need to be
5470 * listed in Administrator's Overview section in high-availability.sgml.
5471 * If you change them, don't forget to update the list.
5472 */
5473static void
5475{
5476 /*
5477 * For archive recovery, the WAL must be generated with at least 'replica'
5478 * wal_level.
5479 */
5481 {
5482 ereport(FATAL,
5484 errmsg("WAL was generated with \"wal_level=minimal\", cannot continue recovering"),
5485 errdetail("This happens if you temporarily set \"wal_level=minimal\" on the server."),
5486 errhint("Use a backup taken after setting \"wal_level\" to higher than \"minimal\".")));
5487 }
5488
5489 /*
5490 * For Hot Standby, the WAL must be generated with 'replica' mode, and we
5491 * must have at least as many backend slots as the primary.
5492 */
5494 {
5495 /* We ignore autovacuum_worker_slots when we make this test. */
5496 RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_connections",
5499 RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_worker_processes",
5502 RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_wal_senders",
5505 RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_prepared_transactions",
5508 RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_locks_per_transaction",
5511 }
5512}
5513
5514/*
5515 * This must be called ONCE during postmaster or standalone-backend startup
5516 */
5517void
5519{
5521 CheckPoint checkPoint;
5522 bool wasShutdown;
5523 bool didCrash;
5524 bool haveTblspcMap;
5525 bool haveBackupLabel;
5534 bool promoted = false;
5535 char timebuf[128];
5536
5537 /*
5538 * We should have an aux process resource owner to use, and we should not
5539 * be in a transaction that's installed some other resowner.
5540 */
5545
5546 /*
5547 * Check that contents look valid.
5548 */
5550 ereport(FATAL,
5552 errmsg("control file contains invalid checkpoint location")));
5553
5554 switch (ControlFile->state)
5555 {
5556 case DB_SHUTDOWNED:
5557
5558 /*
5559 * This is the expected case, so don't be chatty in standalone
5560 * mode
5561 */
5563 (errmsg("database system was shut down at %s",
5565 timebuf, sizeof(timebuf)))));
5566 break;
5567
5569 ereport(LOG,
5570 (errmsg("database system was shut down in recovery at %s",
5572 timebuf, sizeof(timebuf)))));
5573 break;
5574
5575 case DB_SHUTDOWNING:
5576 ereport(LOG,
5577 (errmsg("database system shutdown was interrupted; last known up at %s",
5579 timebuf, sizeof(timebuf)))));
5580 break;
5581
5583 ereport(LOG,
5584 (errmsg("database system was interrupted while in recovery at %s",
5586 timebuf, sizeof(timebuf))),
5587 errhint("This probably means that some data is corrupted and"
5588 " you will have to use the last backup for recovery.")));
5589 break;
5590
5592 ereport(LOG,
5593 (errmsg("database system was interrupted while in recovery at log time %s",
5595 timebuf, sizeof(timebuf))),
5596 errhint("If this has occurred more than once some data might be corrupted"
5597 " and you might need to choose an earlier recovery target.")));
5598 break;
5599
5600 case DB_IN_PRODUCTION:
5601 ereport(LOG,
5602 (errmsg("database system was interrupted; last known up at %s",
5604 timebuf, sizeof(timebuf)))));
5605 break;
5606
5607 default:
5608 ereport(FATAL,
5610 errmsg("control file contains invalid database cluster state")));
5611 }
5612
5613 /* This is just to allow attaching to startup process with a debugger */
5614#ifdef XLOG_REPLAY_DELAY
5616 pg_usleep(60000000L);
5617#endif
5618
5619 /*
5620 * Verify that pg_wal, pg_wal/archive_status, and pg_wal/summaries exist.
5621 * In cases where someone has performed a copy for PITR, these directories
5622 * may have been excluded and need to be re-created.
5623 */
5625
5626 /* Set up timeout handler needed to report startup progress. */
5630
5631 /*----------
5632 * If we previously crashed, perform a couple of actions:
5633 *
5634 * - The pg_wal directory may still include some temporary WAL segments
5635 * used when creating a new segment, so perform some clean up to not
5636 * bloat this path. This is done first as there is no point to sync
5637 * this temporary data.
5638 *
5639 * - There might be data which we had written, intending to fsync it, but
5640 * which we had not actually fsync'd yet. Therefore, a power failure in
5641 * the near future might cause earlier unflushed writes to be lost, even
5642 * though more recent data written to disk from here on would be
5643 * persisted. To avoid that, fsync the entire data directory.
5644 */
5647 {
5650 didCrash = true;
5651 }
5652 else
5653 didCrash = false;
5654
5655 /*
5656 * Prepare for WAL recovery if needed.
5657 *
5658 * InitWalRecovery analyzes the control file and the backup label file, if
5659 * any. It updates the in-memory ControlFile buffer according to the
5660 * starting checkpoint, and sets InRecovery and ArchiveRecoveryRequested.
5661 * It also applies the tablespace map file, if any.
5662 */
5665 checkPoint = ControlFile->checkPointCopy;
5666
5667 /* initialize shared memory variables from the checkpoint record */
5668 TransamVariables->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
5669 TransamVariables->nextOid = checkPoint.nextOid;
5671 MultiXactSetNextMXact(checkPoint.nextMulti, checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
5672 AdvanceOldestClogXid(checkPoint.oldestXid);
5673 SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid, checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
5674 SetMultiXactIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestMulti, checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
5676 checkPoint.newestCommitTsXid);
5677
5678 /*
5679 * Clear out any old relcache cache files. This is *necessary* if we do
5680 * any WAL replay, since that would probably result in the cache files
5681 * being out of sync with database reality. In theory we could leave them
5682 * in place if the database had been cleanly shut down, but it seems
5683 * safest to just remove them always and let them be rebuilt during the
5684 * first backend startup. These files needs to be removed from all
5685 * directories including pg_tblspc, however the symlinks are created only
5686 * after reading tablespace_map file in case of archive recovery from
5687 * backup, so needs to clear old relcache files here after creating
5688 * symlinks.
5689 */
5691
5692 /*
5693 * Initialize replication slots, before there's a chance to remove
5694 * required resources.
5695 */
5697
5698 /*
5699 * Startup the logical decoding status with the last status stored in the
5700 * checkpoint record.
5701 */
5703
5704 /*
5705 * Startup logical state, needs to be setup now so we have proper data
5706 * during crash recovery.
5707 */
5709
5710 /*
5711 * Startup CLOG. This must be done after TransamVariables->nextXid has
5712 * been initialized and before we accept connections or begin WAL replay.
5713 */
5714 StartupCLOG();
5715
5716 /*
5717 * Startup MultiXact. We need to do this early to be able to replay
5718 * truncations.
5719 */
5721
5722 /*
5723 * Ditto for commit timestamps. Activate the facility if the setting is
5724 * enabled in the control file, as there should be no tracking of commit
5725 * timestamps done when the setting was disabled. This facility can be
5726 * started or stopped when replaying a XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE record.
5727 */
5730
5731 /*
5732 * Recover knowledge about replay progress of known replication partners.
5733 */
5735
5736 /*
5737 * Initialize unlogged LSN. On a clean shutdown, it's restored from the
5738 * control file. On recovery, all unlogged relations are blown away, so
5739 * the unlogged LSN counter can be reset too.
5740 */
5744 else
5747
5748 /*
5749 * Copy any missing timeline history files between 'now' and the recovery
5750 * target timeline from archive to pg_wal. While we don't need those files
5751 * ourselves - the history file of the recovery target timeline covers all
5752 * the previous timelines in the history too - a cascading standby server
5753 * might be interested in them. Or, if you archive the WAL from this
5754 * server to a different archive than the primary, it'd be good for all
5755 * the history files to get archived there after failover, so that you can
5756 * use one of the old timelines as a PITR target. Timeline history files
5757 * are small, so it's better to copy them unnecessarily than not copy them
5758 * and regret later.
5759 */
5761
5762 /*
5763 * Before running in recovery, scan pg_twophase and fill in its status to
5764 * be able to work on entries generated by redo. Doing a scan before
5765 * taking any recovery action has the merit to discard any 2PC files that
5766 * are newer than the first record to replay, saving from any conflicts at
5767 * replay. This avoids as well any subsequent scans when doing recovery
5768 * of the on-disk two-phase data.
5769 */
5771
5772 /*
5773 * When starting with crash recovery, reset pgstat data - it might not be
5774 * valid. Otherwise restore pgstat data. It's safe to do this here,
5775 * because postmaster will not yet have started any other processes.
5776 *
5777 * NB: Restoring replication slot stats relies on slot state to have
5778 * already been restored from disk.
5779 *
5780 * TODO: With a bit of extra work we could just start with a pgstat file
5781 * associated with the checkpoint redo location we're starting from.
5782 */
5783 if (didCrash)
5785 else
5787
5789
5792
5793 /* REDO */
5794 if (InRecovery)
5795 {
5796 /* Initialize state for RecoveryInProgress() */
5800 else
5803
5804 /*
5805 * Update pg_control to show that we are recovering and to show the
5806 * selected checkpoint as the place we are starting from. We also mark
5807 * pg_control with any minimum recovery stop point obtained from a
5808 * backup history file.
5809 *
5810 * No need to hold ControlFileLock yet, we aren't up far enough.
5811 */
5813
5814 /*
5815 * If there was a backup label file, it's done its job and the info
5816 * has now been propagated into pg_control. We must get rid of the
5817 * label file so that if we crash during recovery, we'll pick up at
5818 * the latest recovery restartpoint instead of going all the way back
5819 * to the backup start point. It seems prudent though to just rename
5820 * the file out of the way rather than delete it completely.
5821 */
5822 if (haveBackupLabel)
5823 {
5826 }
5827
5828 /*
5829 * If there was a tablespace_map file, it's done its job and the
5830 * symlinks have been created. We must get rid of the map file so
5831 * that if we crash during recovery, we don't create symlinks again.
5832 * It seems prudent though to just rename the file out of the way
5833 * rather than delete it completely.
5834 */
5835 if (haveTblspcMap)
5836 {
5839 }
5840
5841 /*
5842 * Initialize our local copy of minRecoveryPoint. When doing crash
5843 * recovery we want to replay up to the end of WAL. Particularly, in
5844 * the case of a promoted standby minRecoveryPoint value in the
5845 * control file is only updated after the first checkpoint. However,
5846 * if the instance crashes before the first post-recovery checkpoint
5847 * is completed then recovery will use a stale location causing the
5848 * startup process to think that there are still invalid page
5849 * references when checking for data consistency.
5850 */
5852 {
5855 }
5856 else
5857 {
5860 }
5861
5862 /* Check that the GUCs used to generate the WAL allow recovery */
5864
5865 /*
5866 * We're in recovery, so unlogged relations may be trashed and must be
5867 * reset. This should be done BEFORE allowing Hot Standby
5868 * connections, so that read-only backends don't try to read whatever
5869 * garbage is left over from before.
5870 */
5872
5873 /*
5874 * Likewise, delete any saved transaction snapshot files that got left
5875 * behind by crashed backends.
5876 */
5878
5879 /*
5880 * Initialize for Hot Standby, if enabled. We won't let backends in
5881 * yet, not until we've reached the min recovery point specified in
5882 * control file and we've established a recovery snapshot from a
5883 * running-xacts WAL record.
5884 */
5886 {
5887 TransactionId *xids;
5888 int nxids;
5889
5891 (errmsg_internal("initializing for hot standby")));
5892
5894
5895 if (wasShutdown)
5897 else
5898 oldestActiveXID = checkPoint.oldestActiveXid;
5900
5901 /* Tell procarray about the range of xids it has to deal with */
5903
5904 /*
5905 * Startup subtrans only. CLOG, MultiXact and commit timestamp
5906 * have already been started up and other SLRUs are not maintained
5907 * during recovery and need not be started yet.
5908 */
5910
5911 /*
5912 * If we're beginning at a shutdown checkpoint, we know that
5913 * nothing was running on the primary at this point. So fake-up an
5914 * empty running-xacts record and use that here and now. Recover
5915 * additional standby state for prepared transactions.
5916 */
5917 if (wasShutdown)
5918 {
5920 TransactionId latestCompletedXid;
5921
5922 /* Update pg_subtrans entries for any prepared transactions */
5924
5925 /*
5926 * Construct a RunningTransactions snapshot representing a
5927 * shut down server, with only prepared transactions still
5928 * alive. We're never overflowed at this point because all
5929 * subxids are listed with their parent prepared transactions.
5930 */
5931 running.xcnt = nxids;
5932 running.subxcnt = 0;
5934 running.nextXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
5936 latestCompletedXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
5937 TransactionIdRetreat(latestCompletedXid);
5938 Assert(TransactionIdIsNormal(latestCompletedXid));
5939 running.latestCompletedXid = latestCompletedXid;
5940 running.xids = xids;
5941
5943 }
5944 }
5945
5946 /*
5947 * We're all set for replaying the WAL now. Do it.
5948 */
5950 performedWalRecovery = true;
5951 }
5952 else
5953 performedWalRecovery = false;
5954
5955 /*
5956 * Finish WAL recovery.
5957 */
5959 EndOfLog = endOfRecoveryInfo->endOfLog;
5960 EndOfLogTLI = endOfRecoveryInfo->endOfLogTLI;
5961 abortedRecPtr = endOfRecoveryInfo->abortedRecPtr;
5962 missingContrecPtr = endOfRecoveryInfo->missingContrecPtr;
5963
5964 /*
5965 * Reset ps status display, so as no information related to recovery shows
5966 * up.
5967 */
5968 set_ps_display("");
5969
5970 /*
5971 * When recovering from a backup (we are in recovery, and archive recovery
5972 * was requested), complain if we did not roll forward far enough to reach
5973 * the point where the database is consistent. For regular online
5974 * backup-from-primary, that means reaching the end-of-backup WAL record
5975 * (at which point we reset backupStartPoint to be Invalid), for
5976 * backup-from-replica (which can't inject records into the WAL stream),
5977 * that point is when we reach the minRecoveryPoint in pg_control (which
5978 * we purposefully copy last when backing up from a replica). For
5979 * pg_rewind (which creates a backup_label with a method of "pg_rewind")
5980 * or snapshot-style backups (which don't), backupEndRequired will be set
5981 * to false.
5982 *
5983 * Note: it is indeed okay to look at the local variable
5984 * LocalMinRecoveryPoint here, even though ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint
5985 * might be further ahead --- ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint cannot have
5986 * been advanced beyond the WAL we processed.
5987 */
5988 if (InRecovery &&
5991 {
5992 /*
5993 * Ran off end of WAL before reaching end-of-backup WAL record, or
5994 * minRecoveryPoint. That's a bad sign, indicating that you tried to
5995 * recover from an online backup but never called pg_backup_stop(), or
5996 * you didn't archive all the WAL needed.
5997 */
5999 {
6001 ereport(FATAL,
6003 errmsg("WAL ends before end of online backup"),
6004 errhint("All WAL generated while online backup was taken must be available at recovery.")));
6005 else
6006 ereport(FATAL,
6008 errmsg("WAL ends before consistent recovery point")));
6009 }
6010 }
6011
6012 /*
6013 * Reset unlogged relations to the contents of their INIT fork. This is
6014 * done AFTER recovery is complete so as to include any unlogged relations
6015 * created during recovery, but BEFORE recovery is marked as having
6016 * completed successfully. Otherwise we'd not retry if any of the post
6017 * end-of-recovery steps fail.
6018 */
6019 if (InRecovery)
6021
6022 /*
6023 * Pre-scan prepared transactions to find out the range of XIDs present.
6024 * This information is not quite needed yet, but it is positioned here so
6025 * as potential problems are detected before any on-disk change is done.
6026 */
6028
6029 /*
6030 * Allow ordinary WAL segment creation before possibly switching to a new
6031 * timeline, which creates a new segment, and after the last ReadRecord().
6032 */
6034
6035 /*
6036 * Consider whether we need to assign a new timeline ID.
6037 *
6038 * If we did archive recovery, we always assign a new ID. This handles a
6039 * couple of issues. If we stopped short of the end of WAL during
6040 * recovery, then we are clearly generating a new timeline and must assign
6041 * it a unique new ID. Even if we ran to the end, modifying the current
6042 * last segment is problematic because it may result in trying to
6043 * overwrite an already-archived copy of that segment, and we encourage
6044 * DBAs to make their archive_commands reject that. We can dodge the
6045 * problem by making the new active segment have a new timeline ID.
6046 *
6047 * In a normal crash recovery, we can just extend the timeline we were in.
6048 */
6049 newTLI = endOfRecoveryInfo->lastRecTLI;
6051 {
6053 ereport(LOG,
6054 (errmsg("selected new timeline ID: %u", newTLI)));
6055
6056 /*
6057 * Make a writable copy of the last WAL segment. (Note that we also
6058 * have a copy of the last block of the old WAL in
6059 * endOfRecovery->lastPage; we will use that below.)
6060 */
6062
6063 /*
6064 * Remove the signal files out of the way, so that we don't
6065 * accidentally re-enter archive recovery mode in a subsequent crash.
6066 */
6067 if (endOfRecoveryInfo->standby_signal_file_found)
6069
6070 if (endOfRecoveryInfo->recovery_signal_file_found)
6072
6073 /*
6074 * Write the timeline history file, and have it archived. After this
6075 * point (or rather, as soon as the file is archived), the timeline
6076 * will appear as "taken" in the WAL archive and to any standby
6077 * servers. If we crash before actually switching to the new
6078 * timeline, standby servers will nevertheless think that we switched
6079 * to the new timeline, and will try to connect to the new timeline.
6080 * To minimize the window for that, try to do as little as possible
6081 * between here and writing the end-of-recovery record.
6082 */
6084 EndOfLog, endOfRecoveryInfo->recoveryStopReason);
6085
6086 ereport(LOG,
6087 (errmsg("archive recovery complete")));
6088 }
6089
6090 /* Save the selected TimeLineID in shared memory, too */
6095
6096 /*
6097 * Actually, if WAL ended in an incomplete record, skip the parts that
6098 * made it through and start writing after the portion that persisted.
6099 * (It's critical to first write an OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD message, which
6100 * we'll do as soon as we're open for writing new WAL.)
6101 */
6103 {
6104 /*
6105 * We should only have a missingContrecPtr if we're not switching to a
6106 * new timeline. When a timeline switch occurs, WAL is copied from the
6107 * old timeline to the new only up to the end of the last complete
6108 * record, so there can't be an incomplete WAL record that we need to
6109 * disregard.
6110 */
6111 Assert(newTLI == endOfRecoveryInfo->lastRecTLI);
6114 }
6115
6116 /*
6117 * Prepare to write WAL starting at EndOfLog location, and init xlog
6118 * buffer cache using the block containing the last record from the
6119 * previous incarnation.
6120 */
6121 Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
6123 Insert->CurrBytePos = XLogRecPtrToBytePos(EndOfLog);
6124
6125 /*
6126 * Tricky point here: lastPage contains the *last* block that the LastRec
6127 * record spans, not the one it starts in. The last block is indeed the
6128 * one we want to use.
6129 */
6130 if (EndOfLog % XLOG_BLCKSZ != 0)
6131 {
6132 char *page;
6133 int len;
6134 int firstIdx;
6135
6137 len = EndOfLog - endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPageBeginPtr;
6139
6140 /* Copy the valid part of the last block, and zero the rest */
6141 page = &XLogCtl->pages[firstIdx * XLOG_BLCKSZ];
6142 memcpy(page, endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPage, len);
6143 memset(page + len, 0, XLOG_BLCKSZ - len);
6144
6147 }
6148 else
6149 {
6150 /*
6151 * There is no partial block to copy. Just set InitializedUpTo, and
6152 * let the first attempt to insert a log record to initialize the next
6153 * buffer.
6154 */
6156 }
6157
6158 /*
6159 * Update local and shared status. This is OK to do without any locks
6160 * because no other process can be reading or writing WAL yet.
6161 */
6168
6169 /*
6170 * Preallocate additional log files, if wanted.
6171 */
6173
6174 /*
6175 * Okay, we're officially UP.
6176 */
6177 InRecovery = false;
6178
6179 /* start the archive_timeout timer and LSN running */
6182
6183 /* also initialize latestCompletedXid, to nextXid - 1 */
6188
6189 /*
6190 * Start up subtrans, if not already done for hot standby. (commit
6191 * timestamps are started below, if necessary.)
6192 */
6195
6196 /*
6197 * Perform end of recovery actions for any SLRUs that need it.
6198 */
6199 TrimCLOG();
6200 TrimMultiXact();
6201
6202 /*
6203 * Reload shared-memory state for prepared transactions. This needs to
6204 * happen before renaming the last partial segment of the old timeline as
6205 * it may be possible that we have to recover some transactions from it.
6206 */
6208
6209 /* Shut down xlogreader */
6211
6212 /* Enable WAL writes for this backend only. */
6214
6215 /* If necessary, write overwrite-contrecord before doing anything else */
6217 {
6220 }
6221
6222 /*
6223 * Update full_page_writes in shared memory and write an XLOG_FPW_CHANGE
6224 * record before resource manager writes cleanup WAL records or checkpoint
6225 * record is written.
6226 */
6227 Insert->fullPageWrites = lastFullPageWrites;
6229
6230 /*
6231 * Emit checkpoint or end-of-recovery record in XLOG, if required.
6232 */
6235
6236 /*
6237 * If any of the critical GUCs have changed, log them before we allow
6238 * backends to write WAL.
6239 */
6241
6242 /* If this is archive recovery, perform post-recovery cleanup actions. */
6245
6246 /*
6247 * Local WAL inserts enabled, so it's time to finish initialization of
6248 * commit timestamp.
6249 */
6251
6252 /*
6253 * Update logical decoding status in shared memory and write an
6254 * XLOG_LOGICAL_DECODING_STATUS_CHANGE, if necessary.
6255 */
6257
6258 /* Clean up EndOfWalRecoveryInfo data to appease Valgrind leak checking */
6259 if (endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPage)
6260 pfree(endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPage);
6261 pfree(endOfRecoveryInfo->recoveryStopReason);
6263
6264 /*
6265 * All done with end-of-recovery actions.
6266 *
6267 * Now allow backends to write WAL and update the control file status in
6268 * consequence. SharedRecoveryState, that controls if backends can write
6269 * WAL, is updated while holding ControlFileLock to prevent other backends
6270 * to look at an inconsistent state of the control file in shared memory.
6271 * There is still a small window during which backends can write WAL and
6272 * the control file is still referring to a system not in DB_IN_PRODUCTION
6273 * state while looking at the on-disk control file.
6274 *
6275 * Also, we use info_lck to update SharedRecoveryState to ensure that
6276 * there are no race conditions concerning visibility of other recent
6277 * updates to shared memory.
6278 */
6281
6285
6288
6289 /*
6290 * Wake up the checkpointer process as there might be a request to disable
6291 * logical decoding by concurrent slot drop.
6292 */
6294
6295 /*
6296 * Wake up all waiters. They need to report an error that recovery was
6297 * ended before reaching the target LSN.
6298 */
6302
6303 /*
6304 * Shutdown the recovery environment. This must occur after
6305 * RecoverPreparedTransactions() (see notes in lock_twophase_recover())
6306 * and after switching SharedRecoveryState to RECOVERY_STATE_DONE so as
6307 * any session building a snapshot will not rely on KnownAssignedXids as
6308 * RecoveryInProgress() would return false at this stage. This is
6309 * particularly critical for prepared 2PC transactions, that would still
6310 * need to be included in snapshots once recovery has ended.
6311 */
6314
6315 /*
6316 * If there were cascading standby servers connected to us, nudge any wal
6317 * sender processes to notice that we've been promoted.
6318 */
6319 WalSndWakeup(true, true);
6320
6321 /*
6322 * If this was a promotion, request an (online) checkpoint now. This isn't
6323 * required for consistency, but the last restartpoint might be far back,
6324 * and in case of a crash, recovering from it might take a longer than is
6325 * appropriate now that we're not in standby mode anymore.
6326 */
6327 if (promoted)
6329}
6330
6331/*
6332 * Callback from PerformWalRecovery(), called when we switch from crash
6333 * recovery to archive recovery mode. Updates the control file accordingly.
6334 */
6335void
6337{
6338 /* initialize minRecoveryPoint to this record */
6341 if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < EndRecPtr)
6342 {
6343 ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = EndRecPtr;
6344 ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = replayTLI;
6345 }
6346 /* update local copy */
6349
6350 /*
6351 * The startup process can update its local copy of minRecoveryPoint from
6352 * this point.
6353 */
6355
6357
6358 /*
6359 * We update SharedRecoveryState while holding the lock on ControlFileLock
6360 * so both states are consistent in shared memory.
6361 */
6365
6367}
6368
6369/*
6370 * Callback from PerformWalRecovery(), called when we reach the end of backup.
6371 * Updates the control file accordingly.
6372 */
6373void
6375{
6376 /*
6377 * We have reached the end of base backup, as indicated by pg_control. The
6378 * data on disk is now consistent (unless minRecoveryPoint is further
6379 * ahead, which can happen if we crashed during previous recovery). Reset
6380 * backupStartPoint and backupEndPoint, and update minRecoveryPoint to
6381 * make sure we don't allow starting up at an earlier point even if
6382 * recovery is stopped and restarted soon after this.
6383 */
6385
6386 if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < EndRecPtr)
6387 {
6388 ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = EndRecPtr;
6390 }
6391
6396
6398}
6399
6400/*
6401 * Perform whatever XLOG actions are necessary at end of REDO.
6402 *
6403 * The goal here is to make sure that we'll be able to recover properly if
6404 * we crash again. If we choose to write a checkpoint, we'll write a shutdown
6405 * checkpoint rather than an on-line one. This is not particularly critical,
6406 * but since we may be assigning a new TLI, using a shutdown checkpoint allows
6407 * us to have the rule that TLI only changes in shutdown checkpoints, which
6408 * allows some extra error checking in xlog_redo.
6409 */
6410static bool
6412{
6413 bool promoted = false;
6414
6415 /*
6416 * Perform a checkpoint to update all our recovery activity to disk.
6417 *
6418 * Note that we write a shutdown checkpoint rather than an on-line one.
6419 * This is not particularly critical, but since we may be assigning a new
6420 * TLI, using a shutdown checkpoint allows us to have the rule that TLI
6421 * only changes in shutdown checkpoints, which allows some extra error
6422 * checking in xlog_redo.
6423 *
6424 * In promotion, only create a lightweight end-of-recovery record instead
6425 * of a full checkpoint. A checkpoint is requested later, after we're
6426 * fully out of recovery mode and already accepting queries.
6427 */
6430 {
6431 promoted = true;
6432
6433 /*
6434 * Insert a special WAL record to mark the end of recovery, since we
6435 * aren't doing a checkpoint. That means that the checkpointer process
6436 * may likely be in the middle of a time-smoothed restartpoint and
6437 * could continue to be for minutes after this. That sounds strange,
6438 * but the effect is roughly the same and it would be stranger to try
6439 * to come out of the restartpoint and then checkpoint. We request a
6440 * checkpoint later anyway, just for safety.
6441 */
6443 }
6444 else
6445 {
6449 }
6450
6451 return promoted;
6452}
6453
6454/*
6455 * Is the system still in recovery?
6456 *
6457 * Unlike testing InRecovery, this works in any process that's connected to
6458 * shared memory.
6459 */
6460bool
6462{
6463 /*
6464 * We check shared state each time only until we leave recovery mode. We
6465 * can't re-enter recovery, so there's no need to keep checking after the
6466 * shared variable has once been seen false.
6467 */
6469 return false;
6470 else
6471 {
6472 /*
6473 * use volatile pointer to make sure we make a fresh read of the
6474 * shared variable.
6475 */
6476 volatile XLogCtlData *xlogctl = XLogCtl;
6477
6478 LocalRecoveryInProgress = (xlogctl->SharedRecoveryState != RECOVERY_STATE_DONE);
6479
6480 /*
6481 * Note: We don't need a memory barrier when we're still in recovery.
6482 * We might exit recovery immediately after return, so the caller
6483 * can't rely on 'true' meaning that we're still in recovery anyway.
6484 */
6485
6487 }
6488}
6489
6490/*
6491 * Returns current recovery state from shared memory.
6492 *
6493 * This returned state is kept consistent with the contents of the control
6494 * file. See details about the possible values of RecoveryState in xlog.h.
6495 */
6498{
6499 RecoveryState retval;
6500
6502 retval = XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState;
6504
6505 return retval;
6506}
6507
6508/*
6509 * Is this process allowed to insert new WAL records?
6510 *
6511 * Ordinarily this is essentially equivalent to !RecoveryInProgress().
6512 * But we also have provisions for forcing the result "true" or "false"
6513 * within specific processes regardless of the global state.
6514 */
6515bool
6517{
6518 /*
6519 * If value is "unconditionally true" or "unconditionally false", just
6520 * return it. This provides the normal fast path once recovery is known
6521 * done.
6522 */
6523 if (LocalXLogInsertAllowed >= 0)
6524 return (bool) LocalXLogInsertAllowed;
6525
6526 /*
6527 * Else, must check to see if we're still in recovery.
6528 */
6529 if (RecoveryInProgress())
6530 return false;
6531
6532 /*
6533 * On exit from recovery, reset to "unconditionally true", since there is
6534 * no need to keep checking.
6535 */
6537 return true;
6538}
6539
6540/*
6541 * Make XLogInsertAllowed() return true in the current process only.
6542 *
6543 * Note: it is allowed to switch LocalXLogInsertAllowed back to -1 later,
6544 * and even call LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed() again after that.
6545 *
6546 * Returns the previous value of LocalXLogInsertAllowed.
6547 */
6548static int
6550{
6552
6554
6555 return oldXLogAllowed;
6556}
6557
6558/*
6559 * Return the current Redo pointer from shared memory.
6560 *
6561 * As a side-effect, the local RedoRecPtr copy is updated.
6562 */
6565{
6566 XLogRecPtr ptr;
6567
6568 /*
6569 * The possibly not up-to-date copy in XlogCtl is enough. Even if we
6570 * grabbed a WAL insertion lock to read the authoritative value in
6571 * Insert->RedoRecPtr, someone might update it just after we've released
6572 * the lock.
6573 */
6575 ptr = XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr;
6577
6578 if (RedoRecPtr < ptr)
6579 RedoRecPtr = ptr;
6580
6581 return RedoRecPtr;
6582}
6583
6584/*
6585 * Return information needed to decide whether a modified block needs a
6586 * full-page image to be included in the WAL record.
6587 *
6588 * The returned values are cached copies from backend-private memory, and
6589 * possibly out-of-date or, indeed, uninitialized, in which case they will
6590 * be InvalidXLogRecPtr and false, respectively. XLogInsertRecord will
6591 * re-check them against up-to-date values, while holding the WAL insert lock.
6592 */
6593void
6599
6600/*
6601 * GetInsertRecPtr -- Returns the current insert position.
6602 *
6603 * NOTE: The value *actually* returned is the position of the last full
6604 * xlog page. It lags behind the real insert position by at most 1 page.
6605 * For that, we don't need to scan through WAL insertion locks, and an
6606 * approximation is enough for the current usage of this function.
6607 */
6610{
6612
6616
6617 return recptr;
6618}
6619
6620/*
6621 * GetFlushRecPtr -- Returns the current flush position, ie, the last WAL
6622 * position known to be fsync'd to disk. This should only be used on a
6623 * system that is known not to be in recovery.
6624 */
6627{
6629
6631
6632 /*
6633 * If we're writing and flushing WAL, the time line can't be changing, so
6634 * no lock is required.
6635 */
6636 if (insertTLI)
6638
6639 return LogwrtResult.Flush;
6640}
6641
6642/*
6643 * GetWALInsertionTimeLine -- Returns the current timeline of a system that
6644 * is not in recovery.
6645 */
6648{
6650
6651 /* Since the value can't be changing, no lock is required. */
6652 return XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
6653}
6654
6655/*
6656 * GetWALInsertionTimeLineIfSet -- If the system is not in recovery, returns
6657 * the WAL insertion timeline; else, returns 0. Wherever possible, use
6658 * GetWALInsertionTimeLine() instead, since it's cheaper. Note that this
6659 * function decides recovery has ended as soon as the insert TLI is set, which
6660 * happens before we set XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState to RECOVERY_STATE_DONE.
6661 */
6673
6674/*
6675 * GetLastImportantRecPtr -- Returns the LSN of the last important record
6676 * inserted. All records not explicitly marked as unimportant are considered
6677 * important.
6678 *
6679 * The LSN is determined by computing the maximum of
6680 * WALInsertLocks[i].lastImportantAt.
6681 */
6684{
6686 int i;
6687
6688 for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
6689 {
6691
6692 /*
6693 * Need to take a lock to prevent torn reads of the LSN, which are
6694 * possible on some of the supported platforms. WAL insert locks only
6695 * support exclusive mode, so we have to use that.
6696 */
6699 LWLockRelease(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock);
6700
6701 if (res < last_important)
6702 res = last_important;
6703 }
6704
6705 return res;
6706}
6707
6708/*
6709 * Get the time and LSN of the last xlog segment switch
6710 */
6713{
6714 pg_time_t result;
6715
6716 /* Need WALWriteLock, but shared lock is sufficient */
6718 result = XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchTime;
6721
6722 return result;
6723}
6724
6725/*
6726 * This must be called ONCE during postmaster or standalone-backend shutdown
6727 */
6728void
6730{
6731 /*
6732 * We should have an aux process resource owner to use, and we should not
6733 * be in a transaction that's installed some other resowner.
6734 */
6739
6740 /* Don't be chatty in standalone mode */
6742 (errmsg("shutting down")));
6743
6744 /*
6745 * Signal walsenders to move to stopping state.
6746 */
6748
6749 /*
6750 * Wait for WAL senders to be in stopping state. This prevents commands
6751 * from writing new WAL.
6752 */
6754
6755 if (RecoveryInProgress())
6757 else
6758 {
6759 /*
6760 * If archiving is enabled, rotate the last XLOG file so that all the
6761 * remaining records are archived (postmaster wakes up the archiver
6762 * process one more time at the end of shutdown). The checkpoint
6763 * record will go to the next XLOG file and won't be archived (yet).
6764 */
6765 if (XLogArchivingActive())
6766 RequestXLogSwitch(false);
6767
6769 }
6770}
6771
6772/*
6773 * Log start of a checkpoint.
6774 */
6775static void
6777{
6778 if (restartpoint)
6779 ereport(LOG,
6780 /* translator: the placeholders show checkpoint options */
6781 (errmsg("restartpoint starting:%s%s%s%s%s%s%s%s",
6782 (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN) ? " shutdown" : "",
6783 (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) ? " end-of-recovery" : "",
6784 (flags & CHECKPOINT_FAST) ? " fast" : "",
6785 (flags & CHECKPOINT_FORCE) ? " force" : "",
6786 (flags & CHECKPOINT_WAIT) ? " wait" : "",
6787 (flags & CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_XLOG) ? " wal" : "",
6788 (flags & CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_TIME) ? " time" : "",
6789 (flags & CHECKPOINT_FLUSH_UNLOGGED) ? " flush-unlogged" : "")));
6790 else
6791 ereport(LOG,
6792 /* translator: the placeholders show checkpoint options */
6793 (errmsg("checkpoint starting:%s%s%s%s%s%s%s%s",
6794 (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN) ? " shutdown" : "",
6795 (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) ? " end-of-recovery" : "",
6796 (flags & CHECKPOINT_FAST) ? " fast" : "",
6797 (flags & CHECKPOINT_FORCE) ? " force" : "",
6798 (flags & CHECKPOINT_WAIT) ? " wait" : "",
6799 (flags & CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_XLOG) ? " wal" : "",
6800 (flags & CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_TIME) ? " time" : "",
6801 (flags & CHECKPOINT_FLUSH_UNLOGGED) ? " flush-unlogged" : "")));
6802}
6803
6804/*
6805 * Log end of a checkpoint.
6806 */
6807static void
6809{
6810 long write_msecs,
6811 sync_msecs,
6816
6818
6821
6824
6825 /* Accumulate checkpoint timing summary data, in milliseconds. */
6828
6829 /*
6830 * All of the published timing statistics are accounted for. Only
6831 * continue if a log message is to be written.
6832 */
6833 if (!log_checkpoints)
6834 return;
6835
6838
6839 /*
6840 * Timing values returned from CheckpointStats are in microseconds.
6841 * Convert to milliseconds for consistent printing.
6842 */
6844
6849 average_msecs = (long) ((average_sync_time + 999) / 1000);
6850
6851 /*
6852 * ControlFileLock is not required to see ControlFile->checkPoint and
6853 * ->checkPointCopy here as we are the only updator of those variables at
6854 * this moment.
6855 */
6856 if (restartpoint)
6857 ereport(LOG,
6858 (errmsg("restartpoint complete: wrote %d buffers (%.1f%%), "
6859 "wrote %d SLRU buffers; %d WAL file(s) added, "
6860 "%d removed, %d recycled; write=%ld.%03d s, "
6861 "sync=%ld.%03d s, total=%ld.%03d s; sync files=%d, "
6862 "longest=%ld.%03d s, average=%ld.%03d s; distance=%d kB, "
6863 "estimate=%d kB; lsn=%X/%08X, redo lsn=%X/%08X",
6870 write_msecs / 1000, (int) (write_msecs % 1000),
6871 sync_msecs / 1000, (int) (sync_msecs % 1000),
6872 total_msecs / 1000, (int) (total_msecs % 1000),
6874 longest_msecs / 1000, (int) (longest_msecs % 1000),
6875 average_msecs / 1000, (int) (average_msecs % 1000),
6876 (int) (PrevCheckPointDistance / 1024.0),
6877 (int) (CheckPointDistanceEstimate / 1024.0),
6880 else
6881 ereport(LOG,
6882 (errmsg("checkpoint complete: wrote %d buffers (%.1f%%), "
6883 "wrote %d SLRU buffers; %d WAL file(s) added, "
6884 "%d removed, %d recycled; write=%ld.%03d s, "
6885 "sync=%ld.%03d s, total=%ld.%03d s; sync files=%d, "
6886 "longest=%ld.%03d s, average=%ld.%03d s; distance=%d kB, "
6887 "estimate=%d kB; lsn=%X/%08X, redo lsn=%X/%08X",
6894 write_msecs / 1000, (int) (write_msecs % 1000),
6895 sync_msecs / 1000, (int) (sync_msecs % 1000),
6896 total_msecs / 1000, (int) (total_msecs % 1000),
6898 longest_msecs / 1000, (int) (longest_msecs % 1000),
6899 average_msecs / 1000, (int) (average_msecs % 1000),
6900 (int) (PrevCheckPointDistance / 1024.0),
6901 (int) (CheckPointDistanceEstimate / 1024.0),
6904}
6905
6906/*
6907 * Update the estimate of distance between checkpoints.
6908 *
6909 * The estimate is used to calculate the number of WAL segments to keep
6910 * preallocated, see XLOGfileslop().
6911 */
6912static void
6914{
6915 /*
6916 * To estimate the number of segments consumed between checkpoints, keep a
6917 * moving average of the amount of WAL generated in previous checkpoint
6918 * cycles. However, if the load is bursty, with quiet periods and busy
6919 * periods, we want to cater for the peak load. So instead of a plain
6920 * moving average, let the average decline slowly if the previous cycle
6921 * used less WAL than estimated, but bump it up immediately if it used
6922 * more.
6923 *
6924 * When checkpoints are triggered by max_wal_size, this should converge to
6925 * CheckpointSegments * wal_segment_size,
6926 *
6927 * Note: This doesn't pay any attention to what caused the checkpoint.
6928 * Checkpoints triggered manually with CHECKPOINT command, or by e.g.
6929 * starting a base backup, are counted the same as those created
6930 * automatically. The slow-decline will largely mask them out, if they are
6931 * not frequent. If they are frequent, it seems reasonable to count them
6932 * in as any others; if you issue a manual checkpoint every 5 minutes and
6933 * never let a timed checkpoint happen, it makes sense to base the
6934 * preallocation on that 5 minute interval rather than whatever
6935 * checkpoint_timeout is set to.
6936 */
6937 PrevCheckPointDistance = nbytes;
6938 if (CheckPointDistanceEstimate < nbytes)
6940 else
6942 (0.90 * CheckPointDistanceEstimate + 0.10 * (double) nbytes);
6943}
6944
6945/*
6946 * Update the ps display for a process running a checkpoint. Note that
6947 * this routine should not do any allocations so as it can be called
6948 * from a critical section.
6949 */
6950static void
6952{
6953 /*
6954 * The status is reported only for end-of-recovery and shutdown
6955 * checkpoints or shutdown restartpoints. Updating the ps display is
6956 * useful in those situations as it may not be possible to rely on
6957 * pg_stat_activity to see the status of the checkpointer or the startup
6958 * process.
6959 */
6961 return;
6962
6963 if (reset)
6964 set_ps_display("");
6965 else
6966 {
6967 char activitymsg[128];
6968
6969 snprintf(activitymsg, sizeof(activitymsg), "performing %s%s%s",
6970 (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) ? "end-of-recovery " : "",
6971 (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN) ? "shutdown " : "",
6972 restartpoint ? "restartpoint" : "checkpoint");
6974 }
6975}
6976
6977
6978/*
6979 * Perform a checkpoint --- either during shutdown, or on-the-fly
6980 *
6981 * flags is a bitwise OR of the following:
6982 * CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN: checkpoint is for database shutdown.
6983 * CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY: checkpoint is for end of WAL recovery.
6984 * CHECKPOINT_FAST: finish the checkpoint ASAP, ignoring
6985 * checkpoint_completion_target parameter.
6986 * CHECKPOINT_FORCE: force a checkpoint even if no XLOG activity has occurred
6987 * since the last one (implied by CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN or
6988 * CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY).
6989 * CHECKPOINT_FLUSH_UNLOGGED: also flush buffers of unlogged tables.
6990 *
6991 * Note: flags contains other bits, of interest here only for logging purposes.
6992 * In particular note that this routine is synchronous and does not pay
6993 * attention to CHECKPOINT_WAIT.
6994 *
6995 * If !shutdown then we are writing an online checkpoint. An XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO
6996 * record is inserted into WAL at the logical location of the checkpoint, before
6997 * flushing anything to disk, and when the checkpoint is eventually completed,
6998 * and it is from this point that WAL replay will begin in the case of a recovery
6999 * from this checkpoint. Once everything is written to disk, an
7000 * XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE record is written to complete the checkpoint, and
7001 * points back to the earlier XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO record. This mechanism allows
7002 * other write-ahead log records to be written while the checkpoint is in
7003 * progress, but we must be very careful about order of operations. This function
7004 * may take many minutes to execute on a busy system.
7005 *
7006 * On the other hand, when shutdown is true, concurrent insertion into the
7007 * write-ahead log is impossible, so there is no need for two separate records.
7008 * In this case, we only insert an XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN record, and it's
7009 * both the record marking the completion of the checkpoint and the location
7010 * from which WAL replay would begin if needed.
7011 *
7012 * Returns true if a new checkpoint was performed, or false if it was skipped
7013 * because the system was idle.
7014 */
7015bool
7017{
7018 bool shutdown;
7019 CheckPoint checkPoint;
7023 uint32 freespace;
7027 int nvxids;
7028 int oldXLogAllowed = 0;
7029
7030 /*
7031 * An end-of-recovery checkpoint is really a shutdown checkpoint, just
7032 * issued at a different time.
7033 */
7035 shutdown = true;
7036 else
7037 shutdown = false;
7038
7039 /* sanity check */
7040 if (RecoveryInProgress() && (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) == 0)
7041 elog(ERROR, "can't create a checkpoint during recovery");
7042
7043 /*
7044 * Prepare to accumulate statistics.
7045 *
7046 * Note: because it is possible for log_checkpoints to change while a
7047 * checkpoint proceeds, we always accumulate stats, even if
7048 * log_checkpoints is currently off.
7049 */
7052
7053 /*
7054 * Let smgr prepare for checkpoint; this has to happen outside the
7055 * critical section and before we determine the REDO pointer. Note that
7056 * smgr must not do anything that'd have to be undone if we decide no
7057 * checkpoint is needed.
7058 */
7060
7061 /* Run these points outside the critical section. */
7062 INJECTION_POINT("create-checkpoint-initial", NULL);
7063 INJECTION_POINT_LOAD("create-checkpoint-run");
7064
7065 /*
7066 * Use a critical section to force system panic if we have trouble.
7067 */
7069
7070 if (shutdown)
7071 {
7076 }
7077
7078 /* Begin filling in the checkpoint WAL record */
7079 MemSet(&checkPoint, 0, sizeof(checkPoint));
7080 checkPoint.time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
7081
7082 /*
7083 * For Hot Standby, derive the oldestActiveXid before we fix the redo
7084 * pointer. This allows us to begin accumulating changes to assemble our
7085 * starting snapshot of locks and transactions.
7086 */
7088 checkPoint.oldestActiveXid = GetOldestActiveTransactionId(false, true);
7089 else
7091
7092 /*
7093 * Get location of last important record before acquiring insert locks (as
7094 * GetLastImportantRecPtr() also locks WAL locks).
7095 */
7097
7098 /*
7099 * If this isn't a shutdown or forced checkpoint, and if there has been no
7100 * WAL activity requiring a checkpoint, skip it. The idea here is to
7101 * avoid inserting duplicate checkpoints when the system is idle.
7102 */
7104 CHECKPOINT_FORCE)) == 0)
7105 {
7107 {
7110 (errmsg_internal("checkpoint skipped because system is idle")));
7111 return false;
7112 }
7113 }
7114
7115 /*
7116 * An end-of-recovery checkpoint is created before anyone is allowed to
7117 * write WAL. To allow us to write the checkpoint record, temporarily
7118 * enable XLogInsertAllowed.
7119 */
7120 if (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY)
7122
7124 if (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY)
7126 else
7127 checkPoint.PrevTimeLineID = checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID;
7128
7129 /*
7130 * We must block concurrent insertions while examining insert state.
7131 */
7133
7134 checkPoint.fullPageWrites = Insert->fullPageWrites;
7135 checkPoint.wal_level = wal_level;
7136
7137 if (shutdown)
7138 {
7140
7141 /*
7142 * Compute new REDO record ptr = location of next XLOG record.
7143 *
7144 * Since this is a shutdown checkpoint, there can't be any concurrent
7145 * WAL insertion.
7146 */
7147 freespace = INSERT_FREESPACE(curInsert);
7148 if (freespace == 0)
7149 {
7152 else
7154 }
7155 checkPoint.redo = curInsert;
7156
7157 /*
7158 * Here we update the shared RedoRecPtr for future XLogInsert calls;
7159 * this must be done while holding all the insertion locks.
7160 *
7161 * Note: if we fail to complete the checkpoint, RedoRecPtr will be
7162 * left pointing past where it really needs to point. This is okay;
7163 * the only consequence is that XLogInsert might back up whole buffers
7164 * that it didn't really need to. We can't postpone advancing
7165 * RedoRecPtr because XLogInserts that happen while we are dumping
7166 * buffers must assume that their buffer changes are not included in
7167 * the checkpoint.
7168 */
7169 RedoRecPtr = XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr = checkPoint.redo;
7170 }
7171
7172 /*
7173 * Now we can release the WAL insertion locks, allowing other xacts to
7174 * proceed while we are flushing disk buffers.
7175 */
7177
7178 /*
7179 * If this is an online checkpoint, we have not yet determined the redo
7180 * point. We do so now by inserting the special XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO
7181 * record; the LSN at which it starts becomes the new redo pointer. We
7182 * don't do this for a shutdown checkpoint, because in that case no WAL
7183 * can be written between the redo point and the insertion of the
7184 * checkpoint record itself, so the checkpoint record itself serves to
7185 * mark the redo point.
7186 */
7187 if (!shutdown)
7188 {
7189 /* Include WAL level in record for WAL summarizer's benefit. */
7193
7194 /*
7195 * XLogInsertRecord will have updated XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr in
7196 * shared memory and RedoRecPtr in backend-local memory, but we need
7197 * to copy that into the record that will be inserted when the
7198 * checkpoint is complete.
7199 */
7200 checkPoint.redo = RedoRecPtr;
7201 }
7202
7203 /* Update the info_lck-protected copy of RedoRecPtr as well */
7205 XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr = checkPoint.redo;
7207
7208 /*
7209 * If enabled, log checkpoint start. We postpone this until now so as not
7210 * to log anything if we decided to skip the checkpoint.
7211 */
7212 if (log_checkpoints)
7213 LogCheckpointStart(flags, false);
7214
7215 INJECTION_POINT_CACHED("create-checkpoint-run", NULL);
7216
7217 /* Update the process title */
7218 update_checkpoint_display(flags, false, false);
7219
7221
7222 /*
7223 * Get the other info we need for the checkpoint record.
7224 *
7225 * We don't need to save oldestClogXid in the checkpoint, it only matters
7226 * for the short period in which clog is being truncated, and if we crash
7227 * during that we'll redo the clog truncation and fix up oldestClogXid
7228 * there.
7229 */
7231 checkPoint.nextXid = TransamVariables->nextXid;
7232 checkPoint.oldestXid = TransamVariables->oldestXid;
7235
7240
7242 checkPoint.nextOid = TransamVariables->nextOid;
7243 if (!shutdown)
7244 checkPoint.nextOid += TransamVariables->oidCount;
7246
7248
7250 &checkPoint.nextMulti,
7251 &checkPoint.nextMultiOffset,
7252 &checkPoint.oldestMulti,
7253 &checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
7254
7255 /*
7256 * Having constructed the checkpoint record, ensure all shmem disk buffers
7257 * and commit-log buffers are flushed to disk.
7258 *
7259 * This I/O could fail for various reasons. If so, we will fail to
7260 * complete the checkpoint, but there is no reason to force a system
7261 * panic. Accordingly, exit critical section while doing it.
7262 */
7264
7265 /*
7266 * In some cases there are groups of actions that must all occur on one
7267 * side or the other of a checkpoint record. Before flushing the
7268 * checkpoint record we must explicitly wait for any backend currently
7269 * performing those groups of actions.
7270 *
7271 * One example is end of transaction, so we must wait for any transactions
7272 * that are currently in commit critical sections. If an xact inserted
7273 * its commit record into XLOG just before the REDO point, then a crash
7274 * restart from the REDO point would not replay that record, which means
7275 * that our flushing had better include the xact's update of pg_xact. So
7276 * we wait till he's out of his commit critical section before proceeding.
7277 * See notes in RecordTransactionCommit().
7278 *
7279 * Because we've already released the insertion locks, this test is a bit
7280 * fuzzy: it is possible that we will wait for xacts we didn't really need
7281 * to wait for. But the delay should be short and it seems better to make
7282 * checkpoint take a bit longer than to hold off insertions longer than
7283 * necessary. (In fact, the whole reason we have this issue is that xact.c
7284 * does commit record XLOG insertion and clog update as two separate steps
7285 * protected by different locks, but again that seems best on grounds of
7286 * minimizing lock contention.)
7287 *
7288 * A transaction that has not yet set delayChkptFlags when we look cannot
7289 * be at risk, since it has not inserted its commit record yet; and one
7290 * that's already cleared it is not at risk either, since it's done fixing
7291 * clog and we will correctly flush the update below. So we cannot miss
7292 * any xacts we need to wait for.
7293 */
7295 if (nvxids > 0)
7296 {
7297 do
7298 {
7299 /*
7300 * Keep absorbing fsync requests while we wait. There could even
7301 * be a deadlock if we don't, if the process that prevents the
7302 * checkpoint is trying to add a request to the queue.
7303 */
7305
7307 pg_usleep(10000L); /* wait for 10 msec */
7311 }
7312 pfree(vxids);
7313
7314 CheckPointGuts(checkPoint.redo, flags);
7315
7317 if (nvxids > 0)
7318 {
7319 do
7320 {
7322
7324 pg_usleep(10000L); /* wait for 10 msec */
7328 }
7329 pfree(vxids);
7330
7331 /*
7332 * Take a snapshot of running transactions and write this to WAL. This
7333 * allows us to reconstruct the state of running transactions during
7334 * archive recovery, if required. Skip, if this info disabled.
7335 *
7336 * If we are shutting down, or Startup process is completing crash
7337 * recovery we don't need to write running xact data.
7338 */
7341
7343
7344 /*
7345 * Now insert the checkpoint record into XLOG.
7346 */
7348 XLogRegisterData(&checkPoint, sizeof(checkPoint));
7352
7354
7355 /*
7356 * We mustn't write any new WAL after a shutdown checkpoint, or it will be
7357 * overwritten at next startup. No-one should even try, this just allows
7358 * sanity-checking. In the case of an end-of-recovery checkpoint, we want
7359 * to just temporarily disable writing until the system has exited
7360 * recovery.
7361 */
7362 if (shutdown)
7363 {
7364 if (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY)
7366 else
7367 LocalXLogInsertAllowed = 0; /* never again write WAL */
7368 }
7369
7370 /*
7371 * We now have ProcLastRecPtr = start of actual checkpoint record, recptr
7372 * = end of actual checkpoint record.
7373 */
7374 if (shutdown && checkPoint.redo != ProcLastRecPtr)
7375 ereport(PANIC,
7376 (errmsg("concurrent write-ahead log activity while database system is shutting down")));
7377
7378 /*
7379 * Remember the prior checkpoint's redo ptr for
7380 * UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate()
7381 */
7383
7384 /*
7385 * Update the control file.
7386 */
7388 if (shutdown)
7391 ControlFile->checkPointCopy = checkPoint;
7392 /* crash recovery should always recover to the end of WAL */
7395
7396 /*
7397 * Persist unloggedLSN value. It's reset on crash recovery, so this goes
7398 * unused on non-shutdown checkpoints, but seems useful to store it always
7399 * for debugging purposes.
7400 */
7402
7405
7406 /*
7407 * We are now done with critical updates; no need for system panic if we
7408 * have trouble while fooling with old log segments.
7409 */
7411
7412 /*
7413 * WAL summaries end when the next XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO or
7414 * XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN record is reached. This is the first point
7415 * where (a) we're not inside of a critical section and (b) we can be
7416 * certain that the relevant record has been flushed to disk, which must
7417 * happen before it can be summarized.
7418 *
7419 * If this is a shutdown checkpoint, then this happens reasonably
7420 * promptly: we've only just inserted and flushed the
7421 * XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN record. If this is not a shutdown checkpoint,
7422 * then this might not be very prompt at all: the XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO
7423 * record was written before we began flushing data to disk, and that
7424 * could be many minutes ago at this point. However, we don't XLogFlush()
7425 * after inserting that record, so we're not guaranteed that it's on disk
7426 * until after the above call that flushes the XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE
7427 * record.
7428 */
7430
7431 /*
7432 * Let smgr do post-checkpoint cleanup (eg, deleting old files).
7433 */
7435
7436 /*
7437 * Update the average distance between checkpoints if the prior checkpoint
7438 * exists.
7439 */
7442
7443 INJECTION_POINT("checkpoint-before-old-wal-removal", NULL);
7444
7445 /*
7446 * Delete old log files, those no longer needed for last checkpoint to
7447 * prevent the disk holding the xlog from growing full.
7448 */
7454 {
7455 /*
7456 * Some slots have been invalidated; recalculate the old-segment
7457 * horizon, starting again from RedoRecPtr.
7458 */
7461 }
7462 _logSegNo--;
7464 checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID);
7465
7466 /*
7467 * Make more log segments if needed. (Do this after recycling old log
7468 * segments, since that may supply some of the needed files.)
7469 */
7470 if (!shutdown)
7472
7473 /*
7474 * Truncate pg_subtrans if possible. We can throw away all data before
7475 * the oldest XMIN of any running transaction. No future transaction will
7476 * attempt to reference any pg_subtrans entry older than that (see Asserts
7477 * in subtrans.c). During recovery, though, we mustn't do this because
7478 * StartupSUBTRANS hasn't been called yet.
7479 */
7480 if (!RecoveryInProgress())
7482
7483 /* Real work is done; log and update stats. */
7484 LogCheckpointEnd(false);
7485
7486 /* Reset the process title */
7487 update_checkpoint_display(flags, false, true);
7488
7490 NBuffers,
7494
7495 return true;
7496}
7497
7498/*
7499 * Mark the end of recovery in WAL though without running a full checkpoint.
7500 * We can expect that a restartpoint is likely to be in progress as we
7501 * do this, though we are unwilling to wait for it to complete.
7502 *
7503 * CreateRestartPoint() allows for the case where recovery may end before
7504 * the restartpoint completes so there is no concern of concurrent behaviour.
7505 */
7506static void
7508{
7511
7512 /* sanity check */
7513 if (!RecoveryInProgress())
7514 elog(ERROR, "can only be used to end recovery");
7515
7516 xlrec.end_time = GetCurrentTimestamp();
7517 xlrec.wal_level = wal_level;
7518
7520 xlrec.ThisTimeLineID = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
7521 xlrec.PrevTimeLineID = XLogCtl->PrevTimeLineID;
7523
7525
7529
7531
7532 /*
7533 * Update the control file so that crash recovery can follow the timeline
7534 * changes to this point.
7535 */
7538 ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = xlrec.ThisTimeLineID;
7541
7543}
7544
7545/*
7546 * Write an OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD message.
7547 *
7548 * When on WAL replay we expect a continuation record at the start of a page
7549 * that is not there, recovery ends and WAL writing resumes at that point.
7550 * But it's wrong to resume writing new WAL back at the start of the record
7551 * that was broken, because downstream consumers of that WAL (physical
7552 * replicas) are not prepared to "rewind". So the first action after
7553 * finishing replay of all valid WAL must be to write a record of this type
7554 * at the point where the contrecord was missing; to support xlogreader
7555 * detecting the special case, XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD is also added
7556 * to the page header where the record occurs. xlogreader has an ad-hoc
7557 * mechanism to report metadata about the broken record, which is what we
7558 * use here.
7559 *
7560 * At replay time, XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD instructs xlogreader to
7561 * skip the record it was reading, and pass back the LSN of the skipped
7562 * record, so that its caller can verify (on "replay" of that record) that the
7563 * XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD matches what was effectively overwritten.
7564 *
7565 * 'aborted_lsn' is the beginning position of the record that was incomplete.
7566 * It is included in the WAL record. 'pagePtr' and 'newTLI' point to the
7567 * beginning of the XLOG page where the record is to be inserted. They must
7568 * match the current WAL insert position, they're passed here just so that we
7569 * can verify that.
7570 */
7571static XLogRecPtr
7574{
7579
7580 /* sanity checks */
7581 if (!RecoveryInProgress())
7582 elog(ERROR, "can only be used at end of recovery");
7583 if (pagePtr % XLOG_BLCKSZ != 0)
7584 elog(ERROR, "invalid position for missing continuation record %X/%08X",
7586
7587 /* The current WAL insert position should be right after the page header */
7588 startPos = pagePtr;
7591 else
7594 if (recptr != startPos)
7595 elog(ERROR, "invalid WAL insert position %X/%08X for OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD",
7597
7599
7600 /*
7601 * Initialize the XLOG page header (by GetXLogBuffer), and set the
7602 * XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD flag.
7603 *
7604 * No other backend is allowed to write WAL yet, so acquiring the WAL
7605 * insertion lock is just pro forma.
7606 */
7611
7612 /*
7613 * Insert the XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD record as the first record on the
7614 * page. We know it becomes the first record, because no other backend is
7615 * allowed to write WAL yet.
7616 */
7618 xlrec.overwritten_lsn = aborted_lsn;
7619 xlrec.overwrite_time = GetCurrentTimestamp();
7622
7623 /* check that the record was inserted to the right place */
7624 if (ProcLastRecPtr != startPos)
7625 elog(ERROR, "OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD was inserted to unexpected position %X/%08X",
7627
7629
7631
7632 return recptr;
7633}
7634
7635/*
7636 * Flush all data in shared memory to disk, and fsync
7637 *
7638 * This is the common code shared between regular checkpoints and
7639 * recovery restartpoints.
7640 */
7641static void
7643{
7649
7650 /* Write out all dirty data in SLRUs and the main buffer pool */
7658 CheckPointBuffers(flags);
7659
7660 /* Perform all queued up fsyncs */
7666
7667 /* We deliberately delay 2PC checkpointing as long as possible */
7669}
7670
7671/*
7672 * Save a checkpoint for recovery restart if appropriate
7673 *
7674 * This function is called each time a checkpoint record is read from XLOG.
7675 * It must determine whether the checkpoint represents a safe restartpoint or
7676 * not. If so, the checkpoint record is stashed in shared memory so that
7677 * CreateRestartPoint can consult it. (Note that the latter function is
7678 * executed by the checkpointer, while this one will be executed by the
7679 * startup process.)
7680 */
7681static void
7683{
7684 /*
7685 * Also refrain from creating a restartpoint if we have seen any
7686 * references to non-existent pages. Restarting recovery from the
7687 * restartpoint would not see the references, so we would lose the
7688 * cross-check that the pages belonged to a relation that was dropped
7689 * later.
7690 */
7692 {
7693 elog(DEBUG2,
7694 "could not record restart point at %X/%08X because there are unresolved references to invalid pages",
7695 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(checkPoint->redo));
7696 return;
7697 }
7698
7699 /*
7700 * Copy the checkpoint record to shared memory, so that checkpointer can
7701 * work out the next time it wants to perform a restartpoint.
7702 */
7706 XLogCtl->lastCheckPoint = *checkPoint;
7708}
7709
7710/*
7711 * Establish a restartpoint if possible.
7712 *
7713 * This is similar to CreateCheckPoint, but is used during WAL recovery
7714 * to establish a point from which recovery can roll forward without
7715 * replaying the entire recovery log.
7716 *
7717 * Returns true if a new restartpoint was established. We can only establish
7718 * a restartpoint if we have replayed a safe checkpoint record since last
7719 * restartpoint.
7720 */
7721bool
7723{
7724 XLogRecPtr lastCheckPointRecPtr;
7725 XLogRecPtr lastCheckPointEndPtr;
7726 CheckPoint lastCheckPoint;
7730 TimeLineID replayTLI;
7731 XLogRecPtr endptr;
7734
7735 /* Concurrent checkpoint/restartpoint cannot happen */
7737
7738 /* Get a local copy of the last safe checkpoint record. */
7740 lastCheckPointRecPtr = XLogCtl->lastCheckPointRecPtr;
7741 lastCheckPointEndPtr = XLogCtl->lastCheckPointEndPtr;
7742 lastCheckPoint = XLogCtl->lastCheckPoint;
7744
7745 /*
7746 * Check that we're still in recovery mode. It's ok if we exit recovery
7747 * mode after this check, the restart point is valid anyway.
7748 */
7749 if (!RecoveryInProgress())
7750 {
7752 (errmsg_internal("skipping restartpoint, recovery has already ended")));
7753 return false;
7754 }
7755
7756 /*
7757 * If the last checkpoint record we've replayed is already our last
7758 * restartpoint, we can't perform a new restart point. We still update
7759 * minRecoveryPoint in that case, so that if this is a shutdown restart
7760 * point, we won't start up earlier than before. That's not strictly
7761 * necessary, but when hot standby is enabled, it would be rather weird if
7762 * the database opened up for read-only connections at a point-in-time
7763 * before the last shutdown. Such time travel is still possible in case of
7764 * immediate shutdown, though.
7765 *
7766 * We don't explicitly advance minRecoveryPoint when we do create a
7767 * restartpoint. It's assumed that flushing the buffers will do that as a
7768 * side-effect.
7769 */
7770 if (!XLogRecPtrIsValid(lastCheckPointRecPtr) ||
7771 lastCheckPoint.redo <= ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo)
7772 {
7774 errmsg_internal("skipping restartpoint, already performed at %X/%08X",
7775 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(lastCheckPoint.redo)));
7776
7778 if (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN)
7779 {
7784 }
7785 return false;
7786 }
7787
7788 /*
7789 * Update the shared RedoRecPtr so that the startup process can calculate
7790 * the number of segments replayed since last restartpoint, and request a
7791 * restartpoint if it exceeds CheckPointSegments.
7792 *
7793 * Like in CreateCheckPoint(), hold off insertions to update it, although
7794 * during recovery this is just pro forma, because no WAL insertions are
7795 * happening.
7796 */
7798 RedoRecPtr = XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr = lastCheckPoint.redo;
7800
7801 /* Also update the info_lck-protected copy */
7803 XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr = lastCheckPoint.redo;
7805
7806 /*
7807 * Prepare to accumulate statistics.
7808 *
7809 * Note: because it is possible for log_checkpoints to change while a
7810 * checkpoint proceeds, we always accumulate stats, even if
7811 * log_checkpoints is currently off.
7812 */
7815
7816 if (log_checkpoints)
7817 LogCheckpointStart(flags, true);
7818
7819 /* Update the process title */
7820 update_checkpoint_display(flags, true, false);
7821
7822 CheckPointGuts(lastCheckPoint.redo, flags);
7823
7824 /*
7825 * This location needs to be after CheckPointGuts() to ensure that some
7826 * work has already happened during this checkpoint.
7827 */
7828 INJECTION_POINT("create-restart-point", NULL);
7829
7830 /*
7831 * Remember the prior checkpoint's redo ptr for
7832 * UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate()
7833 */
7835
7836 /*
7837 * Update pg_control, using current time. Check that it still shows an
7838 * older checkpoint, else do nothing; this is a quick hack to make sure
7839 * nothing really bad happens if somehow we get here after the
7840 * end-of-recovery checkpoint.
7841 */
7843 if (ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo < lastCheckPoint.redo)
7844 {
7845 /*
7846 * Update the checkpoint information. We do this even if the cluster
7847 * does not show DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY to match with the set of WAL
7848 * segments recycled below.
7849 */
7850 ControlFile->checkPoint = lastCheckPointRecPtr;
7851 ControlFile->checkPointCopy = lastCheckPoint;
7852
7853 /*
7854 * Ensure minRecoveryPoint is past the checkpoint record and update it
7855 * if the control file still shows DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY. Normally,
7856 * this will have happened already while writing out dirty buffers,
7857 * but not necessarily - e.g. because no buffers were dirtied. We do
7858 * this because a backup performed in recovery uses minRecoveryPoint
7859 * to determine which WAL files must be included in the backup, and
7860 * the file (or files) containing the checkpoint record must be
7861 * included, at a minimum. Note that for an ordinary restart of
7862 * recovery there's no value in having the minimum recovery point any
7863 * earlier than this anyway, because redo will begin just after the
7864 * checkpoint record.
7865 */
7867 {
7868 if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < lastCheckPointEndPtr)
7869 {
7870 ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = lastCheckPointEndPtr;
7872
7873 /* update local copy */
7876 }
7877 if (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN)
7879 }
7881 }
7883
7884 /*
7885 * Update the average distance between checkpoints/restartpoints if the
7886 * prior checkpoint exists.
7887 */
7890
7891 /*
7892 * Delete old log files, those no longer needed for last restartpoint to
7893 * prevent the disk holding the xlog from growing full.
7894 */
7896
7897 /*
7898 * Retreat _logSegNo using the current end of xlog replayed or received,
7899 * whichever is later.
7900 */
7902 replayPtr = GetXLogReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
7903 endptr = (receivePtr < replayPtr) ? replayPtr : receivePtr;
7904 KeepLogSeg(endptr, &_logSegNo);
7908 {
7909 /*
7910 * Some slots have been invalidated; recalculate the old-segment
7911 * horizon, starting again from RedoRecPtr.
7912 */
7914 KeepLogSeg(endptr, &_logSegNo);
7915 }
7916 _logSegNo--;
7917
7918 /*
7919 * Try to recycle segments on a useful timeline. If we've been promoted
7920 * since the beginning of this restartpoint, use the new timeline chosen
7921 * at end of recovery. If we're still in recovery, use the timeline we're
7922 * currently replaying.
7923 *
7924 * There is no guarantee that the WAL segments will be useful on the
7925 * current timeline; if recovery proceeds to a new timeline right after
7926 * this, the pre-allocated WAL segments on this timeline will not be used,
7927 * and will go wasted until recycled on the next restartpoint. We'll live
7928 * with that.
7929 */
7930 if (!RecoveryInProgress())
7931 replayTLI = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
7932
7933 RemoveOldXlogFiles(_logSegNo, RedoRecPtr, endptr, replayTLI);
7934
7935 /*
7936 * Make more log segments if needed. (Do this after recycling old log
7937 * segments, since that may supply some of the needed files.)
7938 */
7939 PreallocXlogFiles(endptr, replayTLI);
7940
7941 /*
7942 * Truncate pg_subtrans if possible. We can throw away all data before
7943 * the oldest XMIN of any running transaction. No future transaction will
7944 * attempt to reference any pg_subtrans entry older than that (see Asserts
7945 * in subtrans.c). When hot standby is disabled, though, we mustn't do
7946 * this because StartupSUBTRANS hasn't been called yet.
7947 */
7948 if (EnableHotStandby)
7950
7951 /* Real work is done; log and update stats. */
7952 LogCheckpointEnd(true);
7953
7954 /* Reset the process title */
7955 update_checkpoint_display(flags, true, true);
7956
7959 errmsg("recovery restart point at %X/%08X",
7960 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(lastCheckPoint.redo)),
7961 xtime ? errdetail("Last completed transaction was at log time %s.",
7963
7964 /*
7965 * Finally, execute archive_cleanup_command, if any.
7966 */
7969 "archive_cleanup_command",
7970 false,
7972
7973 return true;
7974}
7975
7976/*
7977 * Report availability of WAL for the given target LSN
7978 * (typically a slot's restart_lsn)
7979 *
7980 * Returns one of the following enum values:
7981 *
7982 * * WALAVAIL_RESERVED means targetLSN is available and it is in the range of
7983 * max_wal_size.
7984 *
7985 * * WALAVAIL_EXTENDED means it is still available by preserving extra
7986 * segments beyond max_wal_size. If max_slot_wal_keep_size is smaller
7987 * than max_wal_size, this state is not returned.
7988 *
7989 * * WALAVAIL_UNRESERVED means it is being lost and the next checkpoint will
7990 * remove reserved segments. The walsender using this slot may return to the
7991 * above.
7992 *
7993 * * WALAVAIL_REMOVED means it has been removed. A replication stream on
7994 * a slot with this LSN cannot continue. (Any associated walsender
7995 * processes should have been terminated already.)
7996 *
7997 * * WALAVAIL_INVALID_LSN means the slot hasn't been set to reserve WAL.
7998 */
8001{
8002 XLogRecPtr currpos; /* current write LSN */
8003 XLogSegNo currSeg; /* segid of currpos */
8004 XLogSegNo targetSeg; /* segid of targetLSN */
8005 XLogSegNo oldestSeg; /* actual oldest segid */
8006 XLogSegNo oldestSegMaxWalSize; /* oldest segid kept by max_wal_size */
8007 XLogSegNo oldestSlotSeg; /* oldest segid kept by slot */
8009
8010 /*
8011 * slot does not reserve WAL. Either deactivated, or has never been active
8012 */
8014 return WALAVAIL_INVALID_LSN;
8015
8016 /*
8017 * Calculate the oldest segment currently reserved by all slots,
8018 * considering wal_keep_size and max_slot_wal_keep_size. Initialize
8019 * oldestSlotSeg to the current segment.
8020 */
8021 currpos = GetXLogWriteRecPtr();
8023 KeepLogSeg(currpos, &oldestSlotSeg);
8024
8025 /*
8026 * Find the oldest extant segment file. We get 1 until checkpoint removes
8027 * the first WAL segment file since startup, which causes the status being
8028 * wrong under certain abnormal conditions but that doesn't actually harm.
8029 */
8031
8032 /* calculate oldest segment by max_wal_size */
8035
8036 if (currSeg > keepSegs)
8038 else
8040
8041 /* the segment we care about */
8043
8044 /*
8045 * No point in returning reserved or extended status values if the
8046 * targetSeg is known to be lost.
8047 */
8048 if (targetSeg >= oldestSlotSeg)
8049 {
8050 /* show "reserved" when targetSeg is within max_wal_size */
8052 return WALAVAIL_RESERVED;
8053
8054 /* being retained by slots exceeding max_wal_size */
8055 return WALAVAIL_EXTENDED;
8056 }
8057
8058 /* WAL segments are no longer retained but haven't been removed yet */
8059 if (targetSeg >= oldestSeg)
8060 return WALAVAIL_UNRESERVED;
8061
8062 /* Definitely lost */
8063 return WALAVAIL_REMOVED;
8064}
8065
8066
8067/*
8068 * Retreat *logSegNo to the last segment that we need to retain because of
8069 * either wal_keep_size or replication slots.
8070 *
8071 * This is calculated by subtracting wal_keep_size from the given xlog
8072 * location, recptr and by making sure that that result is below the
8073 * requirement of replication slots. For the latter criterion we do consider
8074 * the effects of max_slot_wal_keep_size: reserve at most that much space back
8075 * from recptr.
8076 *
8077 * Note about replication slots: if this function calculates a value
8078 * that's further ahead than what slots need reserved, then affected
8079 * slots need to be invalidated and this function invoked again.
8080 * XXX it might be a good idea to rewrite this function so that
8081 * invalidation is optionally done here, instead.
8082 */
8083static void
8085{
8087 XLogSegNo segno;
8089
8091 segno = currSegNo;
8092
8093 /* Calculate how many segments are kept by slots. */
8096 {
8098
8099 /*
8100 * Account for max_slot_wal_keep_size to avoid keeping more than
8101 * configured. However, don't do that during a binary upgrade: if
8102 * slots were to be invalidated because of this, it would not be
8103 * possible to preserve logical ones during the upgrade.
8104 */
8106 {
8108
8111
8112 if (currSegNo - segno > slot_keep_segs)
8113 segno = currSegNo - slot_keep_segs;
8114 }
8115 }
8116
8117 /*
8118 * If WAL summarization is in use, don't remove WAL that has yet to be
8119 * summarized.
8120 */
8123 {
8125
8127 if (unsummarized_segno < segno)
8128 segno = unsummarized_segno;
8129 }
8130
8131 /* but, keep at least wal_keep_size if that's set */
8132 if (wal_keep_size_mb > 0)
8133 {
8135
8137 if (currSegNo - segno < keep_segs)
8138 {
8139 /* avoid underflow, don't go below 1 */
8140 if (currSegNo <= keep_segs)
8141 segno = 1;
8142 else
8143 segno = currSegNo - keep_segs;
8144 }
8145 }
8146
8147 /* don't delete WAL segments newer than the calculated segment */
8148 if (segno < *logSegNo)
8149 *logSegNo = segno;
8150}
8151
8152/*
8153 * Write a NEXTOID log record
8154 */
8155void
8157{
8159 XLogRegisterData(&nextOid, sizeof(Oid));
8161
8162 /*
8163 * We need not flush the NEXTOID record immediately, because any of the
8164 * just-allocated OIDs could only reach disk as part of a tuple insert or
8165 * update that would have its own XLOG record that must follow the NEXTOID
8166 * record. Therefore, the standard buffer LSN interlock applied to those
8167 * records will ensure no such OID reaches disk before the NEXTOID record
8168 * does.
8169 *
8170 * Note, however, that the above statement only covers state "within" the
8171 * database. When we use a generated OID as a file or directory name, we
8172 * are in a sense violating the basic WAL rule, because that filesystem
8173 * change may reach disk before the NEXTOID WAL record does. The impact
8174 * of this is that if a database crash occurs immediately afterward, we
8175 * might after restart re-generate the same OID and find that it conflicts
8176 * with the leftover file or directory. But since for safety's sake we
8177 * always loop until finding a nonconflicting filename, this poses no real
8178 * problem in practice. See pgsql-hackers discussion 27-Sep-2006.
8179 */
8180}
8181
8182/*
8183 * Write an XLOG SWITCH record.
8184 *
8185 * Here we just blindly issue an XLogInsert request for the record.
8186 * All the magic happens inside XLogInsert.
8187 *
8188 * The return value is either the end+1 address of the switch record,
8189 * or the end+1 address of the prior segment if we did not need to
8190 * write a switch record because we are already at segment start.
8191 */
8194{
8196
8197 /* XLOG SWITCH has no data */
8199
8200 if (mark_unimportant)
8203
8204 return RecPtr;
8205}
8206
8207/*
8208 * Write a RESTORE POINT record
8209 */
8212{
8215
8217 strlcpy(xlrec.rp_name, rpName, MAXFNAMELEN);
8218
8221
8223
8224 ereport(LOG,
8225 errmsg("restore point \"%s\" created at %X/%08X",
8227
8228 return RecPtr;
8229}
8230
8231/*
8232 * Check if any of the GUC parameters that are critical for hot standby
8233 * have changed, and update the value in pg_control file if necessary.
8234 */
8235static void
8237{
8246 {
8247 /*
8248 * The change in number of backend slots doesn't need to be WAL-logged
8249 * if archiving is not enabled, as you can't start archive recovery
8250 * with wal_level=minimal anyway. We don't really care about the
8251 * values in pg_control either if wal_level=minimal, but seems better
8252 * to keep them up-to-date to avoid confusion.
8253 */
8255 {
8258
8260 xlrec.max_worker_processes = max_worker_processes;
8261 xlrec.max_wal_senders = max_wal_senders;
8262 xlrec.max_prepared_xacts = max_prepared_xacts;
8263 xlrec.max_locks_per_xact = max_locks_per_xact;
8264 xlrec.wal_level = wal_level;
8265 xlrec.wal_log_hints = wal_log_hints;
8266 xlrec.track_commit_timestamp = track_commit_timestamp;
8267
8269 XLogRegisterData(&xlrec, sizeof(xlrec));
8270
8273 }
8274
8276
8286
8288 }
8289}
8290
8291/*
8292 * Update full_page_writes in shared memory, and write an
8293 * XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record if necessary.
8294 *
8295 * Note: this function assumes there is no other process running
8296 * concurrently that could update it.
8297 */
8298void
8300{
8302 bool recoveryInProgress;
8303
8304 /*
8305 * Do nothing if full_page_writes has not been changed.
8306 *
8307 * It's safe to check the shared full_page_writes without the lock,
8308 * because we assume that there is no concurrently running process which
8309 * can update it.
8310 */
8311 if (fullPageWrites == Insert->fullPageWrites)
8312 return;
8313
8314 /*
8315 * Perform this outside critical section so that the WAL insert
8316 * initialization done by RecoveryInProgress() doesn't trigger an
8317 * assertion failure.
8318 */
8320
8322
8323 /*
8324 * It's always safe to take full page images, even when not strictly
8325 * required, but not the other round. So if we're setting full_page_writes
8326 * to true, first set it true and then write the WAL record. If we're
8327 * setting it to false, first write the WAL record and then set the global
8328 * flag.
8329 */
8330 if (fullPageWrites)
8331 {
8333 Insert->fullPageWrites = true;
8335 }
8336
8337 /*
8338 * Write an XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record. This allows us to keep track of
8339 * full_page_writes during archive recovery, if required.
8340 */
8342 {
8344 XLogRegisterData(&fullPageWrites, sizeof(bool));
8345
8347 }
8348
8349 if (!fullPageWrites)
8350 {
8352 Insert->fullPageWrites = false;
8354 }
8356}
8357
8358/*
8359 * XLOG resource manager's routines
8360 *
8361 * Definitions of info values are in include/catalog/pg_control.h, though
8362 * not all record types are related to control file updates.
8363 *
8364 * NOTE: Some XLOG record types that are directly related to WAL recovery
8365 * are handled in xlogrecovery_redo().
8366 */
8367void
8369{
8370 uint8 info = XLogRecGetInfo(record) & ~XLR_INFO_MASK;
8371 XLogRecPtr lsn = record->EndRecPtr;
8372
8373 /*
8374 * In XLOG rmgr, backup blocks are only used by XLOG_FPI and
8375 * XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT records.
8376 */
8377 Assert(info == XLOG_FPI || info == XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT ||
8378 !XLogRecHasAnyBlockRefs(record));
8379
8380 if (info == XLOG_NEXTOID)
8381 {
8382 Oid nextOid;
8383
8384 /*
8385 * We used to try to take the maximum of TransamVariables->nextOid and
8386 * the recorded nextOid, but that fails if the OID counter wraps
8387 * around. Since no OID allocation should be happening during replay
8388 * anyway, better to just believe the record exactly. We still take
8389 * OidGenLock while setting the variable, just in case.
8390 */
8391 memcpy(&nextOid, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(Oid));
8393 TransamVariables->nextOid = nextOid;
8396 }
8397 else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN)
8398 {
8399 CheckPoint checkPoint;
8400 TimeLineID replayTLI;
8401
8402 memcpy(&checkPoint, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(CheckPoint));
8403 /* In a SHUTDOWN checkpoint, believe the counters exactly */
8405 TransamVariables->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
8408 TransamVariables->nextOid = checkPoint.nextOid;
8412 checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
8413
8415 checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
8416
8417 /*
8418 * No need to set oldestClogXid here as well; it'll be set when we
8419 * redo an xl_clog_truncate if it changed since initialization.
8420 */
8421 SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid, checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
8422
8423 /*
8424 * If we see a shutdown checkpoint while waiting for an end-of-backup
8425 * record, the backup was canceled and the end-of-backup record will
8426 * never arrive.
8427 */
8431 ereport(PANIC,
8432 (errmsg("online backup was canceled, recovery cannot continue")));
8433
8434 /*
8435 * If we see a shutdown checkpoint, we know that nothing was running
8436 * on the primary at this point. So fake-up an empty running-xacts
8437 * record and use that here and now. Recover additional standby state
8438 * for prepared transactions.
8439 */
8441 {
8442 TransactionId *xids;
8443 int nxids;
8445 TransactionId latestCompletedXid;
8447
8449
8450 /* Update pg_subtrans entries for any prepared transactions */
8452
8453 /*
8454 * Construct a RunningTransactions snapshot representing a shut
8455 * down server, with only prepared transactions still alive. We're
8456 * never overflowed at this point because all subxids are listed
8457 * with their parent prepared transactions.
8458 */
8459 running.xcnt = nxids;
8460 running.subxcnt = 0;
8462 running.nextXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
8464 latestCompletedXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
8465 TransactionIdRetreat(latestCompletedXid);
8466 Assert(TransactionIdIsNormal(latestCompletedXid));
8467 running.latestCompletedXid = latestCompletedXid;
8468 running.xids = xids;
8469
8471 }
8472
8473 /* ControlFile->checkPointCopy always tracks the latest ckpt XID */
8477
8478 /*
8479 * We should've already switched to the new TLI before replaying this
8480 * record.
8481 */
8482 (void) GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
8483 if (checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID != replayTLI)
8484 ereport(PANIC,
8485 (errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u (should be %u) in shutdown checkpoint record",
8486 checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID, replayTLI)));
8487
8488 RecoveryRestartPoint(&checkPoint, record);
8489
8490 /*
8491 * After replaying a checkpoint record, free all smgr objects.
8492 * Otherwise we would never do so for dropped relations, as the
8493 * startup does not process shared invalidation messages or call
8494 * AtEOXact_SMgr().
8495 */
8497 }
8498 else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE)
8499 {
8500 CheckPoint checkPoint;
8501 TimeLineID replayTLI;
8502
8503 memcpy(&checkPoint, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(CheckPoint));
8504 /* In an ONLINE checkpoint, treat the XID counter as a minimum */
8507 checkPoint.nextXid))
8508 TransamVariables->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
8510
8511 /*
8512 * We ignore the nextOid counter in an ONLINE checkpoint, preferring
8513 * to track OID assignment through XLOG_NEXTOID records. The nextOid
8514 * counter is from the start of the checkpoint and might well be stale
8515 * compared to later XLOG_NEXTOID records. We could try to take the
8516 * maximum of the nextOid counter and our latest value, but since
8517 * there's no particular guarantee about the speed with which the OID
8518 * counter wraps around, that's a risky thing to do. In any case,
8519 * users of the nextOid counter are required to avoid assignment of
8520 * duplicates, so that a somewhat out-of-date value should be safe.
8521 */
8522
8523 /* Handle multixact */
8525 checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
8526
8527 /*
8528 * NB: This may perform multixact truncation when replaying WAL
8529 * generated by an older primary.
8530 */
8532 checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
8534 checkPoint.oldestXid))
8536 checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
8537 /* ControlFile->checkPointCopy always tracks the latest ckpt XID */
8541
8542 /* TLI should not change in an on-line checkpoint */
8543 (void) GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
8544 if (checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID != replayTLI)
8545 ereport(PANIC,
8546 (errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u (should be %u) in online checkpoint record",
8547 checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID, replayTLI)));
8548
8549 RecoveryRestartPoint(&checkPoint, record);
8550
8551 /*
8552 * After replaying a checkpoint record, free all smgr objects.
8553 * Otherwise we would never do so for dropped relations, as the
8554 * startup does not process shared invalidation messages or call
8555 * AtEOXact_SMgr().
8556 */
8558 }
8559 else if (info == XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD)
8560 {
8561 /* nothing to do here, handled in xlogrecovery_redo() */
8562 }
8563 else if (info == XLOG_END_OF_RECOVERY)
8564 {
8566 TimeLineID replayTLI;
8567
8568 memcpy(&xlrec, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(xl_end_of_recovery));
8569
8570 /*
8571 * For Hot Standby, we could treat this like a Shutdown Checkpoint,
8572 * but this case is rarer and harder to test, so the benefit doesn't
8573 * outweigh the potential extra cost of maintenance.
8574 */
8575
8576 /*
8577 * We should've already switched to the new TLI before replaying this
8578 * record.
8579 */
8580 (void) GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
8581 if (xlrec.ThisTimeLineID != replayTLI)
8582 ereport(PANIC,
8583 (errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u (should be %u) in end-of-recovery record",
8584 xlrec.ThisTimeLineID, replayTLI)));
8585 }
8586 else if (info == XLOG_NOOP)
8587 {
8588 /* nothing to do here */
8589 }
8590 else if (info == XLOG_SWITCH)
8591 {
8592 /* nothing to do here */
8593 }
8594 else if (info == XLOG_RESTORE_POINT)
8595 {
8596 /* nothing to do here, handled in xlogrecovery.c */
8597 }
8598 else if (info == XLOG_FPI || info == XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT)
8599 {
8600 /*
8601 * XLOG_FPI records contain nothing else but one or more block
8602 * references. Every block reference must include a full-page image
8603 * even if full_page_writes was disabled when the record was generated
8604 * - otherwise there would be no point in this record.
8605 *
8606 * XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT records are generated when a page needs to be
8607 * WAL-logged because of a hint bit update. They are only generated
8608 * when checksums and/or wal_log_hints are enabled. They may include
8609 * no full-page images if full_page_writes was disabled when they were
8610 * generated. In this case there is nothing to do here.
8611 *
8612 * No recovery conflicts are generated by these generic records - if a
8613 * resource manager needs to generate conflicts, it has to define a
8614 * separate WAL record type and redo routine.
8615 */
8616 for (uint8 block_id = 0; block_id <= XLogRecMaxBlockId(record); block_id++)
8617 {
8618 Buffer buffer;
8619
8620 if (!XLogRecHasBlockImage(record, block_id))
8621 {
8622 if (info == XLOG_FPI)
8623 elog(ERROR, "XLOG_FPI record did not contain a full-page image");
8624 continue;
8625 }
8626
8627 if (XLogReadBufferForRedo(record, block_id, &buffer) != BLK_RESTORED)
8628 elog(ERROR, "unexpected XLogReadBufferForRedo result when restoring backup block");
8629 UnlockReleaseBuffer(buffer);
8630 }
8631 }
8632 else if (info == XLOG_BACKUP_END)
8633 {
8634 /* nothing to do here, handled in xlogrecovery_redo() */
8635 }
8636 else if (info == XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE)
8637 {
8639
8640 /* Update our copy of the parameters in pg_control */
8641 memcpy(&xlrec, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(xl_parameter_change));
8642
8644 ControlFile->MaxConnections = xlrec.MaxConnections;
8645 ControlFile->max_worker_processes = xlrec.max_worker_processes;
8646 ControlFile->max_wal_senders = xlrec.max_wal_senders;
8647 ControlFile->max_prepared_xacts = xlrec.max_prepared_xacts;
8648 ControlFile->max_locks_per_xact = xlrec.max_locks_per_xact;
8649 ControlFile->wal_level = xlrec.wal_level;
8650 ControlFile->wal_log_hints = xlrec.wal_log_hints;
8651
8652 /*
8653 * Update minRecoveryPoint to ensure that if recovery is aborted, we
8654 * recover back up to this point before allowing hot standby again.
8655 * This is important if the max_* settings are decreased, to ensure
8656 * you don't run queries against the WAL preceding the change. The
8657 * local copies cannot be updated as long as crash recovery is
8658 * happening and we expect all the WAL to be replayed.
8659 */
8661 {
8664 }
8666 {
8667 TimeLineID replayTLI;
8668
8669 (void) GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
8671 ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = replayTLI;
8672 }
8673
8674 CommitTsParameterChange(xlrec.track_commit_timestamp,
8676 ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp = xlrec.track_commit_timestamp;
8677
8680
8681 /* Check to see if any parameter change gives a problem on recovery */
8683 }
8684 else if (info == XLOG_FPW_CHANGE)
8685 {
8686 bool fpw;
8687
8688 memcpy(&fpw, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(bool));
8689
8690 /*
8691 * Update the LSN of the last replayed XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record so that
8692 * do_pg_backup_start() and do_pg_backup_stop() can check whether
8693 * full_page_writes has been disabled during online backup.
8694 */
8695 if (!fpw)
8696 {
8701 }
8702
8703 /* Keep track of full_page_writes */
8705 }
8706 else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO)
8707 {
8708 /* nothing to do here, just for informational purposes */
8709 }
8710 else if (info == XLOG_LOGICAL_DECODING_STATUS_CHANGE)
8711 {
8712 bool status;
8713
8714 memcpy(&status, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(bool));
8715
8716 /*
8717 * We need to toggle the logical decoding status and update the
8718 * XLogLogicalInfo cache of processes synchronously because
8719 * XLogLogicalInfoActive() is used even during read-only queries
8720 * (e.g., via RelationIsAccessibleInLogicalDecoding()). In the
8721 * 'disable' case, it is safe to invalidate existing slots after
8722 * disabling logical decoding because logical decoding cannot process
8723 * subsequent WAL records, which may not contain logical information.
8724 */
8725 if (status)
8727 else
8729
8730 elog(DEBUG1, "update logical decoding status to %d during recovery",
8731 status);
8732
8733 if (InRecovery && InHotStandby)
8734 {
8735 if (!status)
8736 {
8737 /*
8738 * Invalidate logical slots if we are in hot standby and the
8739 * primary disabled logical decoding.
8740 */
8742 0, InvalidOid,
8744 }
8745 else if (sync_replication_slots)
8746 {
8747 /*
8748 * Signal the postmaster to launch the slotsync worker.
8749 *
8750 * XXX: For simplicity, we keep the slotsync worker running
8751 * even after logical decoding is disabled. A future
8752 * improvement can consider starting and stopping the worker
8753 * based on logical decoding status change.
8754 */
8756 }
8757 }
8758 }
8759}
8760
8761/*
8762 * Return the extra open flags used for opening a file, depending on the
8763 * value of the GUCs wal_sync_method, fsync and debug_io_direct.
8764 */
8765static int
8766get_sync_bit(int method)
8767{
8768 int o_direct_flag = 0;
8769
8770 /*
8771 * Use O_DIRECT if requested, except in walreceiver process. The WAL
8772 * written by walreceiver is normally read by the startup process soon
8773 * after it's written. Also, walreceiver performs unaligned writes, which
8774 * don't work with O_DIRECT, so it is required for correctness too.
8775 */
8778
8779 /* If fsync is disabled, never open in sync mode */
8780 if (!enableFsync)
8781 return o_direct_flag;
8782
8783 switch (method)
8784 {
8785 /*
8786 * enum values for all sync options are defined even if they are
8787 * not supported on the current platform. But if not, they are
8788 * not included in the enum option array, and therefore will never
8789 * be seen here.
8790 */
8794 return o_direct_flag;
8795#ifdef O_SYNC
8797 return O_SYNC | o_direct_flag;
8798#endif
8799#ifdef O_DSYNC
8801 return O_DSYNC | o_direct_flag;
8802#endif
8803 default:
8804 /* can't happen (unless we are out of sync with option array) */
8805 elog(ERROR, "unrecognized \"wal_sync_method\": %d", method);
8806 return 0; /* silence warning */
8807 }
8808}
8809
8810/*
8811 * GUC support
8812 */
8813void
8815{
8817 {
8818 /*
8819 * To ensure that no blocks escape unsynced, force an fsync on the
8820 * currently open log segment (if any). Also, if the open flag is
8821 * changing, close the log file so it will be reopened (with new flag
8822 * bit) at next use.
8823 */
8824 if (openLogFile >= 0)
8825 {
8827 if (pg_fsync(openLogFile) != 0)
8828 {
8829 char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
8830 int save_errno;
8831
8832 save_errno = errno;
8835 errno = save_errno;
8836 ereport(PANIC,
8838 errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m", xlogfname)));
8839 }
8840
8843 XLogFileClose();
8844 }
8845 }
8846}
8847
8848
8849/*
8850 * Issue appropriate kind of fsync (if any) for an XLOG output file.
8851 *
8852 * 'fd' is a file descriptor for the XLOG file to be fsync'd.
8853 * 'segno' is for error reporting purposes.
8854 */
8855void
8857{
8858 char *msg = NULL;
8860
8861 Assert(tli != 0);
8862
8863 /*
8864 * Quick exit if fsync is disabled or write() has already synced the WAL
8865 * file.
8866 */
8867 if (!enableFsync ||
8870 return;
8871
8872 /*
8873 * Measure I/O timing to sync the WAL file for pg_stat_io.
8874 */
8876
8878 switch (wal_sync_method)
8879 {
8881 if (pg_fsync_no_writethrough(fd) != 0)
8882 msg = _("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m");
8883 break;
8884#ifdef HAVE_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH
8886 if (pg_fsync_writethrough(fd) != 0)
8887 msg = _("could not fsync write-through file \"%s\": %m");
8888 break;
8889#endif
8891 if (pg_fdatasync(fd) != 0)
8892 msg = _("could not fdatasync file \"%s\": %m");
8893 break;
8896 /* not reachable */
8897 Assert(false);
8898 break;
8899 default:
8900 ereport(PANIC,
8902 errmsg_internal("unrecognized \"wal_sync_method\": %d", wal_sync_method));
8903 break;
8904 }
8905
8906 /* PANIC if failed to fsync */
8907 if (msg)
8908 {
8909 char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
8910 int save_errno = errno;
8911
8913 errno = save_errno;
8914 ereport(PANIC,
8916 errmsg(msg, xlogfname)));
8917 }
8918
8920
8922 start, 1, 0);
8923}
8924
8925/*
8926 * do_pg_backup_start is the workhorse of the user-visible pg_backup_start()
8927 * function. It creates the necessary starting checkpoint and constructs the
8928 * backup state and tablespace map.
8929 *
8930 * Input parameters are "state" (the backup state), "fast" (if true, we do
8931 * the checkpoint in fast mode), and "tablespaces" (if non-NULL, indicates a
8932 * list of tablespaceinfo structs describing the cluster's tablespaces.).
8933 *
8934 * The tablespace map contents are appended to passed-in parameter
8935 * tablespace_map and the caller is responsible for including it in the backup
8936 * archive as 'tablespace_map'. The tablespace_map file is required mainly for
8937 * tar format in windows as native windows utilities are not able to create
8938 * symlinks while extracting files from tar. However for consistency and
8939 * platform-independence, we do it the same way everywhere.
8940 *
8941 * It fills in "state" with the information required for the backup, such
8942 * as the minimum WAL location that must be present to restore from this
8943 * backup (starttli) and the corresponding timeline ID (starttli).
8944 *
8945 * Every successfully started backup must be stopped by calling
8946 * do_pg_backup_stop() or do_pg_abort_backup(). There can be many
8947 * backups active at the same time.
8948 *
8949 * It is the responsibility of the caller of this function to verify the
8950 * permissions of the calling user!
8951 */
8952void
8953do_pg_backup_start(const char *backupidstr, bool fast, List **tablespaces,
8955{
8957
8958 Assert(state != NULL);
8960
8961 /*
8962 * During recovery, we don't need to check WAL level. Because, if WAL
8963 * level is not sufficient, it's impossible to get here during recovery.
8964 */
8966 ereport(ERROR,
8968 errmsg("WAL level not sufficient for making an online backup"),
8969 errhint("\"wal_level\" must be set to \"replica\" or \"logical\" at server start.")));
8970
8972 ereport(ERROR,
8974 errmsg("backup label too long (max %d bytes)",
8975 MAXPGPATH)));
8976
8977 strlcpy(state->name, backupidstr, sizeof(state->name));
8978
8979 /*
8980 * Mark backup active in shared memory. We must do full-page WAL writes
8981 * during an on-line backup even if not doing so at other times, because
8982 * it's quite possible for the backup dump to obtain a "torn" (partially
8983 * written) copy of a database page if it reads the page concurrently with
8984 * our write to the same page. This can be fixed as long as the first
8985 * write to the page in the WAL sequence is a full-page write. Hence, we
8986 * increment runningBackups then force a CHECKPOINT, to ensure there are
8987 * no dirty pages in shared memory that might get dumped while the backup
8988 * is in progress without having a corresponding WAL record. (Once the
8989 * backup is complete, we need not force full-page writes anymore, since
8990 * we expect that any pages not modified during the backup interval must
8991 * have been correctly captured by the backup.)
8992 *
8993 * Note that forcing full-page writes has no effect during an online
8994 * backup from the standby.
8995 *
8996 * We must hold all the insertion locks to change the value of
8997 * runningBackups, to ensure adequate interlocking against
8998 * XLogInsertRecord().
8999 */
9003
9004 /*
9005 * Ensure we decrement runningBackups if we fail below. NB -- for this to
9006 * work correctly, it is critical that sessionBackupState is only updated
9007 * after this block is over.
9008 */
9010 {
9011 bool gotUniqueStartpoint = false;
9012 DIR *tblspcdir;
9013 struct dirent *de;
9015 int datadirpathlen;
9016
9017 /*
9018 * Force an XLOG file switch before the checkpoint, to ensure that the
9019 * WAL segment the checkpoint is written to doesn't contain pages with
9020 * old timeline IDs. That would otherwise happen if you called
9021 * pg_backup_start() right after restoring from a PITR archive: the
9022 * first WAL segment containing the startup checkpoint has pages in
9023 * the beginning with the old timeline ID. That can cause trouble at
9024 * recovery: we won't have a history file covering the old timeline if
9025 * pg_wal directory was not included in the base backup and the WAL
9026 * archive was cleared too before starting the backup.
9027 *
9028 * This also ensures that we have emitted a WAL page header that has
9029 * XLP_BKP_REMOVABLE off before we emit the checkpoint record.
9030 * Therefore, if a WAL archiver (such as pglesslog) is trying to
9031 * compress out removable backup blocks, it won't remove any that
9032 * occur after this point.
9033 *
9034 * During recovery, we skip forcing XLOG file switch, which means that
9035 * the backup taken during recovery is not available for the special
9036 * recovery case described above.
9037 */
9039 RequestXLogSwitch(false);
9040
9041 do
9042 {
9043 bool checkpointfpw;
9044
9045 /*
9046 * Force a CHECKPOINT. Aside from being necessary to prevent torn
9047 * page problems, this guarantees that two successive backup runs
9048 * will have different checkpoint positions and hence different
9049 * history file names, even if nothing happened in between.
9050 *
9051 * During recovery, establish a restartpoint if possible. We use
9052 * the last restartpoint as the backup starting checkpoint. This
9053 * means that two successive backup runs can have same checkpoint
9054 * positions.
9055 *
9056 * Since the fact that we are executing do_pg_backup_start()
9057 * during recovery means that checkpointer is running, we can use
9058 * RequestCheckpoint() to establish a restartpoint.
9059 *
9060 * We use CHECKPOINT_FAST only if requested by user (via passing
9061 * fast = true). Otherwise this can take awhile.
9062 */
9064 (fast ? CHECKPOINT_FAST : 0));
9065
9066 /*
9067 * Now we need to fetch the checkpoint record location, and also
9068 * its REDO pointer. The oldest point in WAL that would be needed
9069 * to restore starting from the checkpoint is precisely the REDO
9070 * pointer.
9071 */
9073 state->checkpointloc = ControlFile->checkPoint;
9074 state->startpoint = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo;
9078
9080 {
9082
9083 /*
9084 * Check to see if all WAL replayed during online backup
9085 * (i.e., since last restartpoint used as backup starting
9086 * checkpoint) contain full-page writes.
9087 */
9091
9092 if (!checkpointfpw || state->startpoint <= recptr)
9093 ereport(ERROR,
9095 errmsg("WAL generated with \"full_page_writes=off\" was replayed "
9096 "since last restartpoint"),
9097 errhint("This means that the backup being taken on the standby "
9098 "is corrupt and should not be used. "
9099 "Enable \"full_page_writes\" and run CHECKPOINT on the primary, "
9100 "and then try an online backup again.")));
9101
9102 /*
9103 * During recovery, since we don't use the end-of-backup WAL
9104 * record and don't write the backup history file, the
9105 * starting WAL location doesn't need to be unique. This means
9106 * that two base backups started at the same time might use
9107 * the same checkpoint as starting locations.
9108 */
9109 gotUniqueStartpoint = true;
9110 }
9111
9112 /*
9113 * If two base backups are started at the same time (in WAL sender
9114 * processes), we need to make sure that they use different
9115 * checkpoints as starting locations, because we use the starting
9116 * WAL location as a unique identifier for the base backup in the
9117 * end-of-backup WAL record and when we write the backup history
9118 * file. Perhaps it would be better generate a separate unique ID
9119 * for each backup instead of forcing another checkpoint, but
9120 * taking a checkpoint right after another is not that expensive
9121 * either because only few buffers have been dirtied yet.
9122 */
9124 if (XLogCtl->Insert.lastBackupStart < state->startpoint)
9125 {
9126 XLogCtl->Insert.lastBackupStart = state->startpoint;
9127 gotUniqueStartpoint = true;
9128 }
9130 } while (!gotUniqueStartpoint);
9131
9132 /*
9133 * Construct tablespace_map file.
9134 */
9136
9137 /* Collect information about all tablespaces */
9139 while ((de = ReadDir(tblspcdir, PG_TBLSPC_DIR)) != NULL)
9140 {
9141 char fullpath[MAXPGPATH + sizeof(PG_TBLSPC_DIR)];
9142 char linkpath[MAXPGPATH];
9143 char *relpath = NULL;
9144 char *s;
9146 char *badp;
9147 Oid tsoid;
9148
9149 /*
9150 * Try to parse the directory name as an unsigned integer.
9151 *
9152 * Tablespace directories should be positive integers that can be
9153 * represented in 32 bits, with no leading zeroes or trailing
9154 * garbage. If we come across a name that doesn't meet those
9155 * criteria, skip it.
9156 */
9157 if (de->d_name[0] < '1' || de->d_name[1] > '9')
9158 continue;
9159 errno = 0;
9160 tsoid = strtoul(de->d_name, &badp, 10);
9161 if (*badp != '\0' || errno == EINVAL || errno == ERANGE)
9162 continue;
9163
9164 snprintf(fullpath, sizeof(fullpath), "%s/%s", PG_TBLSPC_DIR, de->d_name);
9165
9166 de_type = get_dirent_type(fullpath, de, false, ERROR);
9167
9168 if (de_type == PGFILETYPE_LNK)
9169 {
9171 int rllen;
9172
9173 rllen = readlink(fullpath, linkpath, sizeof(linkpath));
9174 if (rllen < 0)
9175 {
9177 (errmsg("could not read symbolic link \"%s\": %m",
9178 fullpath)));
9179 continue;
9180 }
9181 else if (rllen >= sizeof(linkpath))
9182 {
9184 (errmsg("symbolic link \"%s\" target is too long",
9185 fullpath)));
9186 continue;
9187 }
9188 linkpath[rllen] = '\0';
9189
9190 /*
9191 * Relpath holds the relative path of the tablespace directory
9192 * when it's located within PGDATA, or NULL if it's located
9193 * elsewhere.
9194 */
9195 if (rllen > datadirpathlen &&
9199
9200 /*
9201 * Add a backslash-escaped version of the link path to the
9202 * tablespace map file.
9203 */
9205 for (s = linkpath; *s; s++)
9206 {
9207 if (*s == '\n' || *s == '\r' || *s == '\\')
9210 }
9212 de->d_name, escapedpath.data);
9213 pfree(escapedpath.data);
9214 }
9215 else if (de_type == PGFILETYPE_DIR)
9216 {
9217 /*
9218 * It's possible to use allow_in_place_tablespaces to create
9219 * directories directly under pg_tblspc, for testing purposes
9220 * only.
9221 *
9222 * In this case, we store a relative path rather than an
9223 * absolute path into the tablespaceinfo.
9224 */
9225 snprintf(linkpath, sizeof(linkpath), "%s/%s",
9226 PG_TBLSPC_DIR, de->d_name);
9228 }
9229 else
9230 {
9231 /* Skip any other file type that appears here. */
9232 continue;
9233 }
9234
9236 ti->oid = tsoid;
9237 ti->path = pstrdup(linkpath);
9238 ti->rpath = relpath;
9239 ti->size = -1;
9240
9241 if (tablespaces)
9242 *tablespaces = lappend(*tablespaces, ti);
9243 }
9245
9246 state->starttime = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
9247 }
9249
9250 state->started_in_recovery = backup_started_in_recovery;
9251
9252 /*
9253 * Mark that the start phase has correctly finished for the backup.
9254 */
9256}
9257
9258/*
9259 * Utility routine to fetch the session-level status of a backup running.
9260 */
9263{
9264 return sessionBackupState;
9265}
9266
9267/*
9268 * do_pg_backup_stop
9269 *
9270 * Utility function called at the end of an online backup. It creates history
9271 * file (if required), resets sessionBackupState and so on. It can optionally
9272 * wait for WAL segments to be archived.
9273 *
9274 * "state" is filled with the information necessary to restore from this
9275 * backup with its stop LSN (stoppoint), its timeline ID (stoptli), etc.
9276 *
9277 * It is the responsibility of the caller of this function to verify the
9278 * permissions of the calling user!
9279 */
9280void
9282{
9283 bool backup_stopped_in_recovery = false;
9284 char histfilepath[MAXPGPATH];
9288 FILE *fp;
9290 int waits = 0;
9291 bool reported_waiting = false;
9292
9293 Assert(state != NULL);
9294
9296
9297 /*
9298 * During recovery, we don't need to check WAL level. Because, if WAL
9299 * level is not sufficient, it's impossible to get here during recovery.
9300 */
9302 ereport(ERROR,
9304 errmsg("WAL level not sufficient for making an online backup"),
9305 errhint("\"wal_level\" must be set to \"replica\" or \"logical\" at server start.")));
9306
9307 /*
9308 * OK to update backup counter and session-level lock.
9309 *
9310 * Note that CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS() must not occur while updating them,
9311 * otherwise they can be updated inconsistently, which might cause
9312 * do_pg_abort_backup() to fail.
9313 */
9315
9316 /*
9317 * It is expected that each do_pg_backup_start() call is matched by
9318 * exactly one do_pg_backup_stop() call.
9319 */
9322
9323 /*
9324 * Clean up session-level lock.
9325 *
9326 * You might think that WALInsertLockRelease() can be called before
9327 * cleaning up session-level lock because session-level lock doesn't need
9328 * to be protected with WAL insertion lock. But since
9329 * CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS() can occur in it, session-level lock must be
9330 * cleaned up before it.
9331 */
9333
9335
9336 /*
9337 * If we are taking an online backup from the standby, we confirm that the
9338 * standby has not been promoted during the backup.
9339 */
9340 if (state->started_in_recovery && !backup_stopped_in_recovery)
9341 ereport(ERROR,
9343 errmsg("the standby was promoted during online backup"),
9344 errhint("This means that the backup being taken is corrupt "
9345 "and should not be used. "
9346 "Try taking another online backup.")));
9347
9348 /*
9349 * During recovery, we don't write an end-of-backup record. We assume that
9350 * pg_control was backed up last and its minimum recovery point can be
9351 * available as the backup end location. Since we don't have an
9352 * end-of-backup record, we use the pg_control value to check whether
9353 * we've reached the end of backup when starting recovery from this
9354 * backup. We have no way of checking if pg_control wasn't backed up last
9355 * however.
9356 *
9357 * We don't force a switch to new WAL file but it is still possible to
9358 * wait for all the required files to be archived if waitforarchive is
9359 * true. This is okay if we use the backup to start a standby and fetch
9360 * the missing WAL using streaming replication. But in the case of an
9361 * archive recovery, a user should set waitforarchive to true and wait for
9362 * them to be archived to ensure that all the required files are
9363 * available.
9364 *
9365 * We return the current minimum recovery point as the backup end
9366 * location. Note that it can be greater than the exact backup end
9367 * location if the minimum recovery point is updated after the backup of
9368 * pg_control. This is harmless for current uses.
9369 *
9370 * XXX currently a backup history file is for informational and debug
9371 * purposes only. It's not essential for an online backup. Furthermore,
9372 * even if it's created, it will not be archived during recovery because
9373 * an archiver is not invoked. So it doesn't seem worthwhile to write a
9374 * backup history file during recovery.
9375 */
9377 {
9379
9380 /*
9381 * Check to see if all WAL replayed during online backup contain
9382 * full-page writes.
9383 */
9387
9388 if (state->startpoint <= recptr)
9389 ereport(ERROR,
9391 errmsg("WAL generated with \"full_page_writes=off\" was replayed "
9392 "during online backup"),
9393 errhint("This means that the backup being taken on the standby "
9394 "is corrupt and should not be used. "
9395 "Enable \"full_page_writes\" and run CHECKPOINT on the primary, "
9396 "and then try an online backup again.")));
9397
9398
9400 state->stoppoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
9403 }
9404 else
9405 {
9406 char *history_file;
9407
9408 /*
9409 * Write the backup-end xlog record
9410 */
9412 XLogRegisterData(&state->startpoint,
9413 sizeof(state->startpoint));
9415
9416 /*
9417 * Given that we're not in recovery, InsertTimeLineID is set and can't
9418 * change, so we can read it without a lock.
9419 */
9420 state->stoptli = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
9421
9422 /*
9423 * Force a switch to a new xlog segment file, so that the backup is
9424 * valid as soon as archiver moves out the current segment file.
9425 */
9426 RequestXLogSwitch(false);
9427
9428 state->stoptime = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
9429
9430 /*
9431 * Write the backup history file
9432 */
9435 state->startpoint, wal_segment_size);
9436 fp = AllocateFile(histfilepath, "w");
9437 if (!fp)
9438 ereport(ERROR,
9440 errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m",
9441 histfilepath)));
9442
9443 /* Build and save the contents of the backup history file */
9445 fprintf(fp, "%s", history_file);
9447
9448 if (fflush(fp) || ferror(fp) || FreeFile(fp))
9449 ereport(ERROR,
9451 errmsg("could not write file \"%s\": %m",
9452 histfilepath)));
9453
9454 /*
9455 * Clean out any no-longer-needed history files. As a side effect,
9456 * this will post a .ready file for the newly created history file,
9457 * notifying the archiver that history file may be archived
9458 * immediately.
9459 */
9461 }
9462
9463 /*
9464 * If archiving is enabled, wait for all the required WAL files to be
9465 * archived before returning. If archiving isn't enabled, the required WAL
9466 * needs to be transported via streaming replication (hopefully with
9467 * wal_keep_size set high enough), or some more exotic mechanism like
9468 * polling and copying files from pg_wal with script. We have no knowledge
9469 * of those mechanisms, so it's up to the user to ensure that he gets all
9470 * the required WAL.
9471 *
9472 * We wait until both the last WAL file filled during backup and the
9473 * history file have been archived, and assume that the alphabetic sorting
9474 * property of the WAL files ensures any earlier WAL files are safely
9475 * archived as well.
9476 *
9477 * We wait forever, since archive_command is supposed to work and we
9478 * assume the admin wanted his backup to work completely. If you don't
9479 * wish to wait, then either waitforarchive should be passed in as false,
9480 * or you can set statement_timeout. Also, some notices are issued to
9481 * clue in anyone who might be doing this interactively.
9482 */
9483
9484 if (waitforarchive &&
9487 {
9491
9494 state->startpoint, wal_segment_size);
9495
9497 waits = 0;
9498
9501 {
9503
9504 if (!reported_waiting && waits > 5)
9505 {
9507 (errmsg("base backup done, waiting for required WAL segments to be archived")));
9508 reported_waiting = true;
9509 }
9510
9513 1000L,
9516
9518 {
9519 seconds_before_warning *= 2; /* This wraps in >10 years... */
9521 (errmsg("still waiting for all required WAL segments to be archived (%d seconds elapsed)",
9522 waits),
9523 errhint("Check that your \"archive_command\" is executing properly. "
9524 "You can safely cancel this backup, "
9525 "but the database backup will not be usable without all the WAL segments.")));
9526 }
9527 }
9528
9530 (errmsg("all required WAL segments have been archived")));
9531 }
9532 else if (waitforarchive)
9534 (errmsg("WAL archiving is not enabled; you must ensure that all required WAL segments are copied through other means to complete the backup")));
9535}
9536
9537
9538/*
9539 * do_pg_abort_backup: abort a running backup
9540 *
9541 * This does just the most basic steps of do_pg_backup_stop(), by taking the
9542 * system out of backup mode, thus making it a lot more safe to call from
9543 * an error handler.
9544 *
9545 * 'arg' indicates that it's being called during backup setup; so
9546 * sessionBackupState has not been modified yet, but runningBackups has
9547 * already been incremented. When it's false, then it's invoked as a
9548 * before_shmem_exit handler, and therefore we must not change state
9549 * unless sessionBackupState indicates that a backup is actually running.
9550 *
9551 * NB: This gets used as a PG_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP callback and
9552 * before_shmem_exit handler, hence the odd-looking signature.
9553 */
9554void
9556{
9558
9559 /* If called during backup start, there shouldn't be one already running */
9561
9563 {
9567
9570
9573 errmsg("aborting backup due to backend exiting before pg_backup_stop was called"));
9574 }
9575}
9576
9577/*
9578 * Register a handler that will warn about unterminated backups at end of
9579 * session, unless this has already been done.
9580 */
9581void
9583{
9584 static bool already_done = false;
9585
9586 if (already_done)
9587 return;
9589 already_done = true;
9590}
9591
9592/*
9593 * Get latest WAL insert pointer
9594 */
9597{
9600
9601 SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
9602 current_bytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
9603 SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
9604
9606}
9607
9608/*
9609 * Get latest WAL write pointer
9610 */
9618
9619/*
9620 * Returns the redo pointer of the last checkpoint or restartpoint. This is
9621 * the oldest point in WAL that we still need, if we have to restart recovery.
9622 */
9623void
9631
9632/* Thin wrapper around ShutdownWalRcv(). */
9633void
9641
9642/* Enable WAL file recycling and preallocation. */
9643void
9650
9651/* Disable WAL file recycling and preallocation. */
9652void
9659
9660bool
9662{
9663 bool result;
9664
9668
9669 return result;
9670}
9671
9672/*
9673 * Update the WalWriterSleeping flag.
9674 */
9675void
Datum idx(PG_FUNCTION_ARGS)
Definition _int_op.c:262
static void pg_atomic_write_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr, uint64 val)
Definition atomics.h:485
#define pg_memory_barrier()
Definition atomics.h:141
#define pg_read_barrier()
Definition atomics.h:154
static uint64 pg_atomic_read_membarrier_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr)
Definition atomics.h:476
#define pg_write_barrier()
Definition atomics.h:155
static uint64 pg_atomic_monotonic_advance_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr, uint64 target)
Definition atomics.h:595
static uint64 pg_atomic_fetch_add_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr, int64 add_)
Definition atomics.h:532
static void pg_atomic_init_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr, uint64 val)
Definition atomics.h:453
static void pg_atomic_write_membarrier_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr, uint64 val)
Definition atomics.h:504
static uint64 pg_atomic_read_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr)
Definition atomics.h:467
TimeLineID findNewestTimeLine(TimeLineID startTLI)
Definition timeline.c:264
void restoreTimeLineHistoryFiles(TimeLineID begin, TimeLineID end)
Definition timeline.c:50
void writeTimeLineHistory(TimeLineID newTLI, TimeLineID parentTLI, XLogRecPtr switchpoint, char *reason)
Definition timeline.c:304
void startup_progress_timeout_handler(void)
Definition startup.c:303
long TimestampDifferenceMilliseconds(TimestampTz start_time, TimestampTz stop_time)
Definition timestamp.c:1757
bool TimestampDifferenceExceeds(TimestampTz start_time, TimestampTz stop_time, int msec)
Definition timestamp.c:1781
TimestampTz GetCurrentTimestamp(void)
Definition timestamp.c:1645
const char * timestamptz_to_str(TimestampTz t)
Definition timestamp.c:1862
Datum now(PG_FUNCTION_ARGS)
Definition timestamp.c:1609
static bool backup_started_in_recovery
Definition basebackup.c:123
int Buffer
Definition buf.h:23
void CheckPointBuffers(int flags)
Definition bufmgr.c:4342
void UnlockReleaseBuffer(Buffer buffer)
Definition bufmgr.c:5518
#define Min(x, y)
Definition c.h:1007
#define pg_attribute_unused()
Definition c.h:132
#define likely(x)
Definition c.h:421
#define MAXALIGN(LEN)
Definition c.h:836
#define TYPEALIGN(ALIGNVAL, LEN)
Definition c.h:829
uint8_t uint8
Definition c.h:554
#define Max(x, y)
Definition c.h:1001
#define Assert(condition)
Definition c.h:883
#define PG_BINARY
Definition c.h:1281
#define pg_attribute_always_inline
Definition c.h:289
uint64_t uint64
Definition c.h:557
#define unlikely(x)
Definition c.h:422
uint32_t uint32
Definition c.h:556
#define MAXALIGN64(LEN)
Definition c.h:861
#define PG_UINT64_MAX
Definition c.h:617
#define MemSet(start, val, len)
Definition c.h:1023
uint32 TransactionId
Definition c.h:676
size_t Size
Definition c.h:629
#define CATALOG_VERSION_NO
Definition catversion.h:60
void WakeupCheckpointer(void)
void AbsorbSyncRequests(void)
double CheckPointCompletionTarget
void RequestCheckpoint(int flags)
void BootStrapCLOG(void)
Definition clog.c:832
void StartupCLOG(void)
Definition clog.c:843
void CheckPointCLOG(void)
Definition clog.c:903
void TrimCLOG(void)
Definition clog.c:858
void StartupCommitTs(void)
Definition commit_ts.c:608
void CommitTsParameterChange(bool newvalue, bool oldvalue)
Definition commit_ts.c:640
bool track_commit_timestamp
Definition commit_ts.c:109
void CompleteCommitTsInitialization(void)
Definition commit_ts.c:618
void BootStrapCommitTs(void)
Definition commit_ts.c:594
void SetCommitTsLimit(TransactionId oldestXact, TransactionId newestXact)
Definition commit_ts.c:887
void CheckPointCommitTs(void)
Definition commit_ts.c:794
void update_controlfile(const char *DataDir, ControlFileData *ControlFile, bool do_sync)
#define fprintf(file, fmt, msg)
Definition cubescan.l:21
int64 TimestampTz
Definition timestamp.h:39
int errmsg_plural(const char *fmt_singular, const char *fmt_plural, unsigned long n,...)
Definition elog.c:1193
int errmsg_internal(const char *fmt,...)
Definition elog.c:1170
int errcode_for_file_access(void)
Definition elog.c:886
int errdetail(const char *fmt,...)
Definition elog.c:1216
int errhint(const char *fmt,...)
Definition elog.c:1330
int errcode(int sqlerrcode)
Definition elog.c:863
int errmsg(const char *fmt,...)
Definition elog.c:1080
#define _(x)
Definition elog.c:91
#define LOG
Definition elog.h:31
#define FATAL
Definition elog.h:41
#define WARNING
Definition elog.h:36
#define DEBUG2
Definition elog.h:29
#define PANIC
Definition elog.h:42
#define DEBUG1
Definition elog.h:30
#define ERROR
Definition elog.h:39
#define elog(elevel,...)
Definition elog.h:226
#define NOTICE
Definition elog.h:35
#define ereport(elevel,...)
Definition elog.h:150
int MakePGDirectory(const char *directoryName)
Definition fd.c:3959
int FreeDir(DIR *dir)
Definition fd.c:3005
int pg_fsync_no_writethrough(int fd)
Definition fd.c:438
int io_direct_flags
Definition fd.c:168
int durable_rename(const char *oldfile, const char *newfile, int elevel)
Definition fd.c:779
int pg_fdatasync(int fd)
Definition fd.c:477
int CloseTransientFile(int fd)
Definition fd.c:2851
int BasicOpenFile(const char *fileName, int fileFlags)
Definition fd.c:1086
int FreeFile(FILE *file)
Definition fd.c:2823
int pg_fsync_writethrough(int fd)
Definition fd.c:458
void ReleaseExternalFD(void)
Definition fd.c:1221
int data_sync_elevel(int elevel)
Definition fd.c:3982
static void Insert(File file)
Definition fd.c:1297
DIR * AllocateDir(const char *dirname)
Definition fd.c:2887
int durable_unlink(const char *fname, int elevel)
Definition fd.c:869
void ReserveExternalFD(void)
Definition fd.c:1203
struct dirent * ReadDir(DIR *dir, const char *dirname)
Definition fd.c:2953
int pg_fsync(int fd)
Definition fd.c:386
FILE * AllocateFile(const char *name, const char *mode)
Definition fd.c:2624
int OpenTransientFile(const char *fileName, int fileFlags)
Definition fd.c:2674
void SyncDataDirectory(void)
Definition fd.c:3590
#define IO_DIRECT_WAL
Definition fd.h:55
#define IO_DIRECT_WAL_INIT
Definition fd.h:56
#define PG_O_DIRECT
Definition fd.h:112
#define palloc_object(type)
Definition fe_memutils.h:74
ssize_t pg_pwrite_zeros(int fd, size_t size, pgoff_t offset)
Definition file_utils.c:709
PGFileType get_dirent_type(const char *path, const struct dirent *de, bool look_through_symlinks, int elevel)
Definition file_utils.c:547
PGFileType
Definition file_utils.h:19
@ PGFILETYPE_LNK
Definition file_utils.h:24
@ PGFILETYPE_DIR
Definition file_utils.h:23
@ PGFILETYPE_REG
Definition file_utils.h:22
bool IsBinaryUpgrade
Definition globals.c:121
int NBuffers
Definition globals.c:142
pid_t PostmasterPid
Definition globals.c:106
bool enableFsync
Definition globals.c:129
ProcNumber MyProcNumber
Definition globals.c:90
bool IsUnderPostmaster
Definition globals.c:120
int MaxConnections
Definition globals.c:143
volatile uint32 CritSectionCount
Definition globals.c:45
char * DataDir
Definition globals.c:71
bool IsPostmasterEnvironment
Definition globals.c:119
struct Latch * MyLatch
Definition globals.c:63
int max_worker_processes
Definition globals.c:144
int set_config_option_ext(const char *name, const char *value, GucContext context, GucSource source, Oid srole, GucAction action, bool changeVal, int elevel, bool is_reload)
Definition guc.c:3256
void SetConfigOption(const char *name, const char *value, GucContext context, GucSource source)
Definition guc.c:4196
void * guc_malloc(int elevel, size_t size)
Definition guc.c:636
#define newval
struct config_generic * find_option(const char *name, bool create_placeholders, bool skip_errors, int elevel)
Definition guc.c:1113
@ GUC_ACTION_SET
Definition guc.h:203
#define GUC_check_errdetail
Definition guc.h:505
GucSource
Definition guc.h:112
@ PGC_S_DYNAMIC_DEFAULT
Definition guc.h:114
@ PGC_S_OVERRIDE
Definition guc.h:123
@ PGC_INTERNAL
Definition guc.h:73
@ PGC_POSTMASTER
Definition guc.h:74
return str start
#define TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE
Definition heaptoast.h:84
#define bufsize
#define INJECTION_POINT(name, arg)
#define INJECTION_POINT_CACHED(name, arg)
#define INJECTION_POINT_LOAD(name)
WalUsage pgWalUsage
Definition instrument.c:22
#define close(a)
Definition win32.h:12
#define write(a, b, c)
Definition win32.h:14
#define read(a, b, c)
Definition win32.h:13
void before_shmem_exit(pg_on_exit_callback function, Datum arg)
Definition ipc.c:344
#define PG_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP(cleanup_function, arg)
Definition ipc.h:47
#define PG_END_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP(cleanup_function, arg)
Definition ipc.h:52
int i
Definition isn.c:77
#define LOBLKSIZE
void SetLatch(Latch *latch)
Definition latch.c:290
void ResetLatch(Latch *latch)
Definition latch.c:374
int WaitLatch(Latch *latch, int wakeEvents, long timeout, uint32 wait_event_info)
Definition latch.c:172
List * lappend(List *list, void *datum)
Definition list.c:339
void list_free(List *list)
Definition list.c:1546
int max_locks_per_xact
Definition lock.c:53
void UpdateLogicalDecodingStatusEndOfRecovery(void)
Definition logicalctl.c:553
bool IsLogicalDecodingEnabled(void)
Definition logicalctl.c:204
bool IsXLogLogicalInfoEnabled(void)
Definition logicalctl.c:220
void StartupLogicalDecodingStatus(bool last_status)
Definition logicalctl.c:146
void DisableLogicalDecoding(void)
Definition logicalctl.c:491
void EnableLogicalDecoding(void)
Definition logicalctl.c:340
void LWLockUpdateVar(LWLock *lock, pg_atomic_uint64 *valptr, uint64 val)
Definition lwlock.c:1728
void LWLockReleaseClearVar(LWLock *lock, pg_atomic_uint64 *valptr, uint64 val)
Definition lwlock.c:1866
bool LWLockAcquire(LWLock *lock, LWLockMode mode)
Definition lwlock.c:1176
bool LWLockWaitForVar(LWLock *lock, pg_atomic_uint64 *valptr, uint64 oldval, uint64 *newval)
Definition lwlock.c:1592
void LWLockRelease(LWLock *lock)
Definition lwlock.c:1793
void LWLockInitialize(LWLock *lock, int tranche_id)
Definition lwlock.c:698
bool LWLockConditionalAcquire(LWLock *lock, LWLockMode mode)
Definition lwlock.c:1347
bool LWLockAcquireOrWait(LWLock *lock, LWLockMode mode)
Definition lwlock.c:1404
@ LW_SHARED
Definition lwlock.h:113
@ LW_EXCLUSIVE
Definition lwlock.h:112
char * pstrdup(const char *in)
Definition mcxt.c:1781
void pfree(void *pointer)
Definition mcxt.c:1616
MemoryContext TopMemoryContext
Definition mcxt.c:166
void * palloc(Size size)
Definition mcxt.c:1387
void MemoryContextAllowInCriticalSection(MemoryContext context, bool allow)
Definition mcxt.c:743
#define AllocSetContextCreate
Definition memutils.h:129
#define ALLOCSET_DEFAULT_SIZES
Definition memutils.h:160
#define AmStartupProcess()
Definition miscadmin.h:390
#define IsBootstrapProcessingMode()
Definition miscadmin.h:477
#define START_CRIT_SECTION()
Definition miscadmin.h:150
#define CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS()
Definition miscadmin.h:123
@ B_CHECKPOINTER
Definition miscadmin.h:363
#define END_CRIT_SECTION()
Definition miscadmin.h:152
#define AmWalReceiverProcess()
Definition miscadmin.h:391
bool process_shared_preload_libraries_done
Definition miscinit.c:1787
BackendType MyBackendType
Definition miscinit.c:64
void MultiXactSetNextMXact(MultiXactId nextMulti, MultiXactOffset nextMultiOffset)
Definition multixact.c:1992
void MultiXactAdvanceOldest(MultiXactId oldestMulti, Oid oldestMultiDB)
Definition multixact.c:2191
void MultiXactGetCheckptMulti(bool is_shutdown, MultiXactId *nextMulti, MultiXactOffset *nextMultiOffset, MultiXactId *oldestMulti, Oid *oldestMultiDB)
Definition multixact.c:1946
void CheckPointMultiXact(void)
Definition multixact.c:1968
void TrimMultiXact(void)
Definition multixact.c:1834
void MultiXactAdvanceNextMXact(MultiXactId minMulti, MultiXactOffset minMultiOffset)
Definition multixact.c:2164
void BootStrapMultiXact(void)
Definition multixact.c:1793
void StartupMultiXact(void)
Definition multixact.c:1809
void SetMultiXactIdLimit(MultiXactId oldest_datminmxid, Oid oldest_datoid)
Definition multixact.c:2014
#define FirstMultiXactId
Definition multixact.h:26
void StartupReplicationOrigin(void)
Definition origin.c:728
void CheckPointReplicationOrigin(void)
Definition origin.c:602
static MemoryContext MemoryContextSwitchTo(MemoryContext context)
Definition palloc.h:124
void * arg
#define ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED
#define INDEX_MAX_KEYS
#define NAMEDATALEN
#define MAXPGPATH
#define DEFAULT_XLOG_SEG_SIZE
#define SLRU_PAGES_PER_SEGMENT
#define PG_IO_ALIGN_SIZE
#define PG_CACHE_LINE_SIZE
#define FLOATFORMAT_VALUE
Definition pg_control.h:203
#define XLOG_RESTORE_POINT
Definition pg_control.h:76
#define XLOG_FPW_CHANGE
Definition pg_control.h:77
#define XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO
Definition pg_control.h:83
#define PG_CONTROL_VERSION
Definition pg_control.h:25
#define XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD
Definition pg_control.h:82
#define XLOG_FPI
Definition pg_control.h:80
#define XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT
Definition pg_control.h:79
#define MOCK_AUTH_NONCE_LEN
Definition pg_control.h:28
#define XLOG_NEXTOID
Definition pg_control.h:72
@ DB_IN_PRODUCTION
Definition pg_control.h:99
@ DB_SHUTDOWNING
Definition pg_control.h:96
@ DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY
Definition pg_control.h:98
@ DB_SHUTDOWNED_IN_RECOVERY
Definition pg_control.h:95
@ DB_SHUTDOWNED
Definition pg_control.h:94
@ DB_IN_CRASH_RECOVERY
Definition pg_control.h:97
#define XLOG_NOOP
Definition pg_control.h:71
#define XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN
Definition pg_control.h:69
#define PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE
Definition pg_control.h:260
#define XLOG_SWITCH
Definition pg_control.h:73
#define XLOG_BACKUP_END
Definition pg_control.h:74
#define XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE
Definition pg_control.h:75
#define XLOG_LOGICAL_DECODING_STATUS_CHANGE
Definition pg_control.h:84
#define XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE
Definition pg_control.h:70
#define XLOG_END_OF_RECOVERY
Definition pg_control.h:78
uint32 pg_crc32c
Definition pg_crc32c.h:38
#define COMP_CRC32C(crc, data, len)
Definition pg_crc32c.h:153
#define EQ_CRC32C(c1, c2)
Definition pg_crc32c.h:42
#define INIT_CRC32C(crc)
Definition pg_crc32c.h:41
#define FIN_CRC32C(crc)
Definition pg_crc32c.h:158
const void size_t len
return crc
static char * filename
Definition pg_dumpall.c:120
#define lfirst(lc)
Definition pg_list.h:172
static rewind_source * source
Definition pg_rewind.c:89
static char buf[DEFAULT_XLOG_SEG_SIZE]
bool pgstat_report_fixed
Definition pgstat.c:218
void pgstat_restore_stats(void)
Definition pgstat.c:507
void pgstat_discard_stats(void)
Definition pgstat.c:519
@ IOOBJECT_WAL
Definition pgstat.h:279
@ IOCONTEXT_INIT
Definition pgstat.h:288
@ IOCONTEXT_NORMAL
Definition pgstat.h:289
@ IOOP_FSYNC
Definition pgstat.h:308
@ IOOP_WRITE
Definition pgstat.h:316
PgStat_CheckpointerStats PendingCheckpointerStats
instr_time pgstat_prepare_io_time(bool track_io_guc)
Definition pgstat_io.c:91
void pgstat_count_io_op_time(IOObject io_object, IOContext io_context, IOOp io_op, instr_time start_time, uint32 cnt, uint64 bytes)
Definition pgstat_io.c:122
int64 pg_time_t
Definition pgtime.h:23
size_t pg_strftime(char *s, size_t maxsize, const char *format, const struct pg_tm *t)
Definition strftime.c:128
struct pg_tm * pg_localtime(const pg_time_t *timep, const pg_tz *tz)
Definition localtime.c:1345
PGDLLIMPORT pg_tz * log_timezone
Definition pgtz.c:31
bool pg_strong_random(void *buf, size_t len)
int pg_strcasecmp(const char *s1, const char *s2)
#define pg_pwrite
Definition port.h:248
#define snprintf
Definition port.h:260
#define IS_DIR_SEP(ch)
Definition port.h:103
size_t strlcpy(char *dst, const char *src, size_t siz)
Definition strlcpy.c:45
static bool DatumGetBool(Datum X)
Definition postgres.h:100
static Datum BoolGetDatum(bool X)
Definition postgres.h:112
uint64_t Datum
Definition postgres.h:70
#define InvalidOid
unsigned int Oid
void CheckPointPredicate(void)
Definition predicate.c:1041
static int fd(const char *x, int i)
static int fb(int x)
short access
#define GetPGProcByNumber(n)
Definition proc.h:446
#define DELAY_CHKPT_START
Definition proc.h:135
#define DELAY_CHKPT_COMPLETE
Definition proc.h:136
bool MinimumActiveBackends(int min)
Definition procarray.c:3508
TransactionId GetOldestTransactionIdConsideredRunning(void)
Definition procarray.c:1984
bool HaveVirtualXIDsDelayingChkpt(VirtualTransactionId *vxids, int nvxids, int type)
Definition procarray.c:3052
void ProcArrayApplyRecoveryInfo(RunningTransactions running)
Definition procarray.c:1056
TransactionId GetOldestActiveTransactionId(bool inCommitOnly, bool allDbs)
Definition procarray.c:2835
void ProcArrayInitRecovery(TransactionId initializedUptoXID)
Definition procarray.c:1025
VirtualTransactionId * GetVirtualXIDsDelayingChkpt(int *nvxids, int type)
Definition procarray.c:3007
#define INVALID_PROC_NUMBER
Definition procnumber.h:26
int ProcNumber
Definition procnumber.h:24
static void set_ps_display(const char *activity)
Definition ps_status.h:40
void ResetUnloggedRelations(int op)
Definition reinit.c:47
#define UNLOGGED_RELATION_INIT
Definition reinit.h:28
#define UNLOGGED_RELATION_CLEANUP
Definition reinit.h:27
void RelationCacheInitFileRemove(void)
Definition relcache.c:6895
void CheckPointRelationMap(void)
Definition relmapper.c:611
#define relpath(rlocator, forknum)
Definition relpath.h:150
#define PG_TBLSPC_DIR
Definition relpath.h:41
void StartupReorderBuffer(void)
ResourceOwner CurrentResourceOwner
Definition resowner.c:173
ResourceOwner AuxProcessResourceOwner
Definition resowner.c:176
void CheckPointLogicalRewriteHeap(void)
#define RM_MAX_ID
Definition rmgr.h:33
Size add_size(Size s1, Size s2)
Definition shmem.c:495
Size mul_size(Size s1, Size s2)
Definition shmem.c:510
void * ShmemInitStruct(const char *name, Size size, bool *foundPtr)
Definition shmem.c:389
void pg_usleep(long microsec)
Definition signal.c:53
void CheckPointReplicationSlots(bool is_shutdown)
Definition slot.c:2300
void StartupReplicationSlots(void)
Definition slot.c:2378
bool InvalidateObsoleteReplicationSlots(uint32 possible_causes, XLogSegNo oldestSegno, Oid dboid, TransactionId snapshotConflictHorizon)
Definition slot.c:2196
@ RS_INVAL_WAL_REMOVED
Definition slot.h:62
@ RS_INVAL_IDLE_TIMEOUT
Definition slot.h:68
@ RS_INVAL_WAL_LEVEL
Definition slot.h:66
bool sync_replication_slots
Definition slotsync.c:117
void smgrdestroyall(void)
Definition smgr.c:386
void CheckPointSnapBuild(void)
Definition snapbuild.c:1969
void DeleteAllExportedSnapshotFiles(void)
Definition snapmgr.c:1587
#define SpinLockInit(lock)
Definition spin.h:57
#define SpinLockRelease(lock)
Definition spin.h:61
#define SpinLockAcquire(lock)
Definition spin.h:59
void reset(void)
PGPROC * MyProc
Definition proc.c:67
PROC_HDR * ProcGlobal
Definition proc.c:79
XLogRecPtr LogStandbySnapshot(void)
Definition standby.c:1282
void InitRecoveryTransactionEnvironment(void)
Definition standby.c:95
void ShutdownRecoveryTransactionEnvironment(void)
Definition standby.c:161
@ SUBXIDS_IN_SUBTRANS
Definition standby.h:82
void appendStringInfo(StringInfo str, const char *fmt,...)
Definition stringinfo.c:145
void appendBinaryStringInfo(StringInfo str, const void *data, int datalen)
Definition stringinfo.c:281
void appendStringInfoString(StringInfo str, const char *s)
Definition stringinfo.c:230
void appendStringInfoChar(StringInfo str, char ch)
Definition stringinfo.c:242
void initStringInfo(StringInfo str)
Definition stringinfo.c:97
Oid oldestMultiDB
Definition pg_control.h:52
MultiXactId oldestMulti
Definition pg_control.h:51
MultiXactOffset nextMultiOffset
Definition pg_control.h:48
TransactionId newestCommitTsXid
Definition pg_control.h:56
TransactionId oldestXid
Definition pg_control.h:49
TimeLineID PrevTimeLineID
Definition pg_control.h:40
TimeLineID ThisTimeLineID
Definition pg_control.h:39
TransactionId oldestActiveXid
Definition pg_control.h:65
bool fullPageWrites
Definition pg_control.h:42
MultiXactId nextMulti
Definition pg_control.h:47
FullTransactionId nextXid
Definition pg_control.h:45
TransactionId oldestCommitTsXid
Definition pg_control.h:54
pg_time_t time
Definition pg_control.h:53
int wal_level
Definition pg_control.h:43
bool logicalDecodingEnabled
Definition pg_control.h:44
XLogRecPtr redo
Definition pg_control.h:37
Oid oldestXidDB
Definition pg_control.h:50
uint64 ckpt_agg_sync_time
Definition xlog.h:187
uint64 ckpt_longest_sync
Definition xlog.h:186
TimestampTz ckpt_start_t
Definition xlog.h:172
TimestampTz ckpt_end_t
Definition xlog.h:176
int ckpt_segs_removed
Definition xlog.h:182
TimestampTz ckpt_write_t
Definition xlog.h:173
TimestampTz ckpt_sync_end_t
Definition xlog.h:175
TimestampTz ckpt_sync_t
Definition xlog.h:174
int ckpt_bufs_written
Definition xlog.h:178
int ckpt_segs_recycled
Definition xlog.h:183
int ckpt_slru_written
Definition xlog.h:179
char mock_authentication_nonce[MOCK_AUTH_NONCE_LEN]
Definition pg_control.h:239
uint32 pg_control_version
Definition pg_control.h:127
uint32 xlog_seg_size
Definition pg_control.h:215
XLogRecPtr backupStartPoint
Definition pg_control.h:172
bool track_commit_timestamp
Definition pg_control.h:187
CheckPoint checkPointCopy
Definition pg_control.h:137
uint32 slru_pages_per_segment
Definition pg_control.h:212
XLogRecPtr backupEndPoint
Definition pg_control.h:173
XLogRecPtr minRecoveryPoint
Definition pg_control.h:170
uint32 data_checksum_version
Definition pg_control.h:226
XLogRecPtr unloggedLSN
Definition pg_control.h:139
uint32 indexMaxKeys
Definition pg_control.h:218
pg_time_t time
Definition pg_control.h:134
bool default_char_signedness
Definition pg_control.h:232
XLogRecPtr checkPoint
Definition pg_control.h:135
uint64 system_identifier
Definition pg_control.h:112
uint32 catalog_version_no
Definition pg_control.h:128
TimeLineID minRecoveryPointTLI
Definition pg_control.h:171
pg_crc32c crc
Definition pg_control.h:242
uint32 toast_max_chunk_size
Definition pg_control.h:220
Definition dirent.c:26
Definition pg_list.h:54
char data[XLOG_BLCKSZ]
Definition c.h:1139
ProcNumber walwriterProc
Definition proc.h:430
PgStat_Counter sync_time
Definition pgstat.h:265
PgStat_Counter write_time
Definition pgstat.h:264
void(* rm_mask)(char *pagedata, BlockNumber blkno)
TransactionId oldestRunningXid
Definition standby.h:92
TransactionId nextXid
Definition standby.h:91
TransactionId latestCompletedXid
Definition standby.h:95
subxids_array_status subxid_status
Definition standby.h:90
TransactionId * xids
Definition standby.h:97
TransactionId oldestCommitTsXid
Definition transam.h:232
TransactionId newestCommitTsXid
Definition transam.h:233
FullTransactionId latestCompletedXid
Definition transam.h:238
FullTransactionId nextXid
Definition transam.h:220
TransactionId oldestXid
Definition transam.h:222
pg_atomic_uint64 insertingAt
Definition xlog.c:373
XLogRecPtr lastImportantAt
Definition xlog.c:374
LWLock lock
Definition xlog.c:372
pg_atomic_uint64 minWaitedLSN[WAIT_LSN_TYPE_COUNT]
Definition xlogwait.h:85
int64 wal_buffers_full
Definition instrument.h:57
uint64 wal_bytes
Definition instrument.h:55
int64 wal_fpi
Definition instrument.h:54
uint64 wal_fpi_bytes
Definition instrument.h:56
int64 wal_records
Definition instrument.h:53
CheckPoint lastCheckPoint
Definition xlog.c:547
XLogwrtRqst LogwrtRqst
Definition xlog.c:458
slock_t info_lck
Definition xlog.c:555
XLogRecPtr InitializedUpTo
Definition xlog.c:487
char * pages
Definition xlog.c:494
pg_time_t lastSegSwitchTime
Definition xlog.c:469
XLogRecPtr replicationSlotMinLSN
Definition xlog.c:461
RecoveryState SharedRecoveryState
Definition xlog.c:518
TimeLineID InsertTimeLineID
Definition xlog.c:511
XLogRecPtr lastSegSwitchLSN
Definition xlog.c:470
XLogSegNo lastRemovedSegNo
Definition xlog.c:463
pg_atomic_uint64 * xlblocks
Definition xlog.c:495
pg_atomic_uint64 logWriteResult
Definition xlog.c:474
int XLogCacheBlck
Definition xlog.c:496
XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr
Definition xlog.c:459
XLogRecPtr lastCheckPointRecPtr
Definition xlog.c:545
XLogRecPtr lastFpwDisableRecPtr
Definition xlog.c:553
XLogCtlInsert Insert
Definition xlog.c:455
bool InstallXLogFileSegmentActive
Definition xlog.c:528
bool WalWriterSleeping
Definition xlog.c:535
XLogRecPtr asyncXactLSN
Definition xlog.c:460
XLogRecPtr lastCheckPointEndPtr
Definition xlog.c:546
pg_atomic_uint64 logFlushResult
Definition xlog.c:475
pg_atomic_uint64 logInsertResult
Definition xlog.c:473
TimeLineID PrevTimeLineID
Definition xlog.c:512
pg_atomic_uint64 unloggedLSN
Definition xlog.c:466
WALInsertLockPadded * WALInsertLocks
Definition xlog.c:447
XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr
Definition xlog.c:433
uint64 PrevBytePos
Definition xlog.c:411
char pad[PG_CACHE_LINE_SIZE]
Definition xlog.c:420
int runningBackups
Definition xlog.c:441
slock_t insertpos_lck
Definition xlog.c:401
uint64 CurrBytePos
Definition xlog.c:410
bool fullPageWrites
Definition xlog.c:434
XLogRecPtr lastBackupStart
Definition xlog.c:442
XLogRecPtr xlp_pageaddr
XLogRecPtr EndRecPtr
Definition xlogreader.h:206
XLogRecPtr ReadRecPtr
Definition xlogreader.h:205
XLogRecPtr xl_prev
Definition xlogrecord.h:45
pg_crc32c xl_crc
Definition xlogrecord.h:49
uint8 xl_info
Definition xlogrecord.h:46
uint32 xl_tot_len
Definition xlogrecord.h:43
TransactionId xl_xid
Definition xlogrecord.h:44
RmgrId xl_rmid
Definition xlogrecord.h:47
XLogRecPtr Flush
Definition xlog.c:331
XLogRecPtr Write
Definition xlog.c:330
XLogRecPtr Flush
Definition xlog.c:325
XLogRecPtr Write
Definition xlog.c:324
Definition guc.h:174
TimestampTz rp_time
void StartupSUBTRANS(TransactionId oldestActiveXID)
Definition subtrans.c:283
void CheckPointSUBTRANS(void)
Definition subtrans.c:329
void BootStrapSUBTRANS(void)
Definition subtrans.c:269
void TruncateSUBTRANS(TransactionId oldestXact)
Definition subtrans.c:385
void ProcessSyncRequests(void)
Definition sync.c:286
void SyncPreCheckpoint(void)
Definition sync.c:177
void SyncPostCheckpoint(void)
Definition sync.c:202
TimeoutId RegisterTimeout(TimeoutId id, timeout_handler_proc handler)
Definition timeout.c:505
@ STARTUP_PROGRESS_TIMEOUT
Definition timeout.h:38
#define TransactionIdRetreat(dest)
Definition transam.h:141
#define InvalidTransactionId
Definition transam.h:31
static void FullTransactionIdRetreat(FullTransactionId *dest)
Definition transam.h:103
#define XidFromFullTransactionId(x)
Definition transam.h:48
#define FirstGenbkiObjectId
Definition transam.h:195
#define FirstNormalTransactionId
Definition transam.h:34
#define TransactionIdIsValid(xid)
Definition transam.h:41
static FullTransactionId FullTransactionIdFromEpochAndXid(uint32 epoch, TransactionId xid)
Definition transam.h:71
#define TransactionIdIsNormal(xid)
Definition transam.h:42
#define FullTransactionIdPrecedes(a, b)
Definition transam.h:51
static bool TransactionIdPrecedes(TransactionId id1, TransactionId id2)
Definition transam.h:263
void RecoverPreparedTransactions(void)
Definition twophase.c:2083
void restoreTwoPhaseData(void)
Definition twophase.c:1904
int max_prepared_xacts
Definition twophase.c:116
TransactionId PrescanPreparedTransactions(TransactionId **xids_p, int *nxids_p)
Definition twophase.c:1966
void StandbyRecoverPreparedTransactions(void)
Definition twophase.c:2045
void CheckPointTwoPhase(XLogRecPtr redo_horizon)
Definition twophase.c:1822
WALInsertLock l
Definition xlog.c:386
char pad[PG_CACHE_LINE_SIZE]
Definition xlog.c:387
bool SplitIdentifierString(char *rawstring, char separator, List **namelist)
Definition varlena.c:2730
void SetTransactionIdLimit(TransactionId oldest_datfrozenxid, Oid oldest_datoid)
Definition varsup.c:372
void AdvanceOldestClogXid(TransactionId oldest_datfrozenxid)
Definition varsup.c:355
TransamVariablesData * TransamVariables
Definition varsup.c:34
static void pgstat_report_wait_start(uint32 wait_event_info)
Definition wait_event.h:69
static void pgstat_report_wait_end(void)
Definition wait_event.h:85
#define WL_TIMEOUT
#define WL_EXIT_ON_PM_DEATH
#define WL_LATCH_SET
static TimestampTz wakeup[NUM_WALRCV_WAKEUPS]
XLogRecPtr Flush
XLogRecPtr Write
XLogRecPtr GetWalRcvFlushRecPtr(XLogRecPtr *latestChunkStart, TimeLineID *receiveTLI)
void ShutdownWalRcv(void)
void WalSndWakeup(bool physical, bool logical)
Definition walsender.c:3800
int max_wal_senders
Definition walsender.c:129
void WalSndInitStopping(void)
Definition walsender.c:3879
void WalSndWaitStopping(void)
Definition walsender.c:3905
static void WalSndWakeupProcessRequests(bool physical, bool logical)
Definition walsender.h:65
#define WalSndWakeupRequest()
Definition walsender.h:58
bool summarize_wal
void WaitForWalSummarization(XLogRecPtr lsn)
void WakeupWalSummarizer(void)
XLogRecPtr GetOldestUnsummarizedLSN(TimeLineID *tli, bool *lsn_is_exact)
int WalWriterFlushAfter
Definition walwriter.c:71
int WalWriterDelay
Definition walwriter.c:70
#define stat
Definition win32_port.h:74
#define EINTR
Definition win32_port.h:361
#define S_ISDIR(m)
Definition win32_port.h:315
#define kill(pid, sig)
Definition win32_port.h:490
#define SIGUSR1
Definition win32_port.h:170
#define readlink(path, buf, size)
Definition win32_port.h:226
#define O_CLOEXEC
Definition win32_port.h:344
#define O_DSYNC
Definition win32_port.h:346
int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tp, void *tzp)
void MarkSubxactTopXidLogged(void)
Definition xact.c:592
void MarkCurrentTransactionIdLoggedIfAny(void)
Definition xact.c:542
int XLogFileInit(XLogSegNo logsegno, TimeLineID logtli)
Definition xlog.c:3418
void assign_wal_sync_method(int new_wal_sync_method, void *extra)
Definition xlog.c:8814
static void CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord(void)
Definition xlog.c:7507
uint64 GetSystemIdentifier(void)
Definition xlog.c:4628
int wal_decode_buffer_size
Definition xlog.c:139
XLogRecPtr ProcLastRecPtr
Definition xlog.c:256
static XLogCtlData * XLogCtl
Definition xlog.c:568
bool fullPageWrites
Definition xlog.c:125
void UpdateFullPageWrites(void)
Definition xlog.c:8299
bool RecoveryInProgress(void)
Definition xlog.c:6461
static void CleanupBackupHistory(void)
Definition xlog.c:4199
void GetFullPageWriteInfo(XLogRecPtr *RedoRecPtr_p, bool *doPageWrites_p)
Definition xlog.c:6594
TimeLineID GetWALInsertionTimeLine(void)
Definition xlog.c:6647
XLogRecPtr RequestXLogSwitch(bool mark_unimportant)
Definition xlog.c:8193
void do_pg_abort_backup(int code, Datum arg)
Definition xlog.c:9555
XLogSegNo XLogGetLastRemovedSegno(void)
Definition xlog.c:3796
XLogRecPtr XLogInsertRecord(XLogRecData *rdata, XLogRecPtr fpw_lsn, uint8 flags, int num_fpi, uint64 fpi_bytes, bool topxid_included)
Definition xlog.c:750
char * XLogArchiveCommand
Definition xlog.c:123
int wal_keep_size_mb
Definition xlog.c:119
Size WALReadFromBuffers(char *dstbuf, XLogRecPtr startptr, Size count, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:1755
static XLogRecPtr WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(XLogRecPtr upto)
Definition xlog.c:1511
static void WALInsertLockRelease(void)
Definition xlog.c:1452
static XLogRecPtr XLogBytePosToRecPtr(uint64 bytepos)
Definition xlog.c:1865
bool EnableHotStandby
Definition xlog.c:124
static void WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(XLogRecPtr insertingAt)
Definition xlog.c:1478
XLogRecPtr GetRedoRecPtr(void)
Definition xlog.c:6564
void assign_wal_consistency_checking(const char *newval, void *extra)
Definition xlog.c:4832
static void InitControlFile(uint64 sysidentifier, uint32 data_checksum_version)
Definition xlog.c:4242
void SetInstallXLogFileSegmentActive(void)
Definition xlog.c:9644
static void AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(XLogRecPtr upto, TimeLineID tli, bool opportunistic)
Definition xlog.c:1992
static void WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(void)
Definition xlog.c:1423
static void UpdateControlFile(void)
Definition xlog.c:4619
void StartupXLOG(void)
Definition xlog.c:5518
bool IsInstallXLogFileSegmentActive(void)
Definition xlog.c:9661
static int openLogFile
Definition xlog.c:637
void BootStrapXLOG(uint32 data_checksum_version)
Definition xlog.c:5127
XLogRecPtr XactLastRecEnd
Definition xlog.c:257
bool CreateRestartPoint(int flags)
Definition xlog.c:7722
static void ValidateXLOGDirectoryStructure(void)
Definition xlog.c:4137
int CommitDelay
Definition xlog.c:135
static void RemoveOldXlogFiles(XLogSegNo segno, XLogRecPtr lastredoptr, XLogRecPtr endptr, TimeLineID insertTLI)
Definition xlog.c:3903
static XLogRecPtr CreateOverwriteContrecordRecord(XLogRecPtr aborted_lsn, XLogRecPtr pagePtr, TimeLineID newTLI)
Definition xlog.c:7572
XLogRecPtr GetInsertRecPtr(void)
Definition xlog.c:6609
bool wal_init_zero
Definition xlog.c:130
static void CalculateCheckpointSegments(void)
Definition xlog.c:2175
int XLogArchiveMode
Definition xlog.c:122
SessionBackupState get_backup_status(void)
Definition xlog.c:9262
static void XLogReportParameters(void)
Definition xlog.c:8236
#define RefreshXLogWriteResult(_target)
Definition xlog.c:622
void CheckXLogRemoved(XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:3765
int wal_level
Definition xlog.c:134
static void LogCheckpointStart(int flags, bool restartpoint)
Definition xlog.c:6776
static XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr
Definition xlog.c:276
void assign_checkpoint_completion_target(double newval, void *extra)
Definition xlog.c:2211
static XLogRecPtr XLogGetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN(void)
Definition xlog.c:2683
static bool InstallXLogFileSegment(XLogSegNo *segno, char *tmppath, bool find_free, XLogSegNo max_segno, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:3601
static void WriteControlFile(void)
Definition xlog.c:4277
int wal_segment_size
Definition xlog.c:146
WALAvailability GetWALAvailability(XLogRecPtr targetLSN)
Definition xlog.c:8000
const char * show_archive_command(void)
Definition xlog.c:4885
#define UsableBytesInPage
Definition xlog.c:599
int max_wal_size_mb
Definition xlog.c:117
void XLOGShmemInit(void)
Definition xlog.c:5012
void ShutdownXLOG(int code, Datum arg)
Definition xlog.c:6729
bool DataChecksumsEnabled(void)
Definition xlog.c:4648
static bool PerformRecoveryXLogAction(void)
Definition xlog.c:6411
RecoveryState GetRecoveryState(void)
Definition xlog.c:6497
int XLogArchiveTimeout
Definition xlog.c:121
static void CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery(TimeLineID EndOfLogTLI, XLogRecPtr EndOfLog, TimeLineID newTLI)
Definition xlog.c:5378
#define ConvertToXSegs(x, segsize)
Definition xlog.c:605
bool wal_recycle
Definition xlog.c:131
static void RemoveXlogFile(const struct dirent *segment_de, XLogSegNo recycleSegNo, XLogSegNo *endlogSegNo, TimeLineID insertTLI)
Definition xlog.c:4047
pg_time_t GetLastSegSwitchData(XLogRecPtr *lastSwitchLSN)
Definition xlog.c:6712
const char * show_effective_wal_level(void)
Definition xlog.c:4912
static int XLOGChooseNumBuffers(void)
Definition xlog.c:4694
static XLogRecPtr XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(uint64 bytepos)
Definition xlog.c:1905
static int get_sync_bit(int method)
Definition xlog.c:8766
static XLogwrtResult LogwrtResult
Definition xlog.c:614
void XLogSetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN(XLogRecPtr lsn)
Definition xlog.c:2670
static void LogCheckpointEnd(bool restartpoint)
Definition xlog.c:6808
void SwitchIntoArchiveRecovery(XLogRecPtr EndRecPtr, TimeLineID replayTLI)
Definition xlog.c:6336
static bool lastFullPageWrites
Definition xlog.c:220
char * wal_consistency_checking_string
Definition xlog.c:128
static void WALInsertLockAcquire(void)
Definition xlog.c:1378
int CommitSiblings
Definition xlog.c:136
static void CopyXLogRecordToWAL(int write_len, bool isLogSwitch, XLogRecData *rdata, XLogRecPtr StartPos, XLogRecPtr EndPos, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:1232
bool GetDefaultCharSignedness(void)
Definition xlog.c:4662
static double CheckPointDistanceEstimate
Definition xlog.c:162
static uint64 XLogRecPtrToBytePos(XLogRecPtr ptr)
Definition xlog.c:1948
const char * show_in_hot_standby(void)
Definition xlog.c:4897
XLogRecPtr GetXLogInsertRecPtr(void)
Definition xlog.c:9596
Size XLOGShmemSize(void)
Definition xlog.c:4962
void SetWalWriterSleeping(bool sleeping)
Definition xlog.c:9676
bool wal_log_hints
Definition xlog.c:126
static void XLogInitNewTimeline(TimeLineID endTLI, XLogRecPtr endOfLog, TimeLineID newTLI)
Definition xlog.c:5303
static void CheckRequiredParameterValues(void)
Definition xlog.c:5474
#define XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(recptr)
Definition xlog.c:593
int wal_sync_method
Definition xlog.c:133
int XLogFileOpen(XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:3656
int max_slot_wal_keep_size_mb
Definition xlog.c:138
XLogRecPtr GetFlushRecPtr(TimeLineID *insertTLI)
Definition xlog.c:6626
static void PreallocXlogFiles(XLogRecPtr endptr, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:3728
static bool doPageWrites
Definition xlog.c:289
static bool holdingAllLocks
Definition xlog.c:654
static TimeLineID openLogTLI
Definition xlog.c:639
XLogRecPtr XactLastCommitEnd
Definition xlog.c:258
WalLevel GetActiveWalLevelOnStandby(void)
Definition xlog.c:4953
bool log_checkpoints
Definition xlog.c:132
static void KeepLogSeg(XLogRecPtr recptr, XLogSegNo *logSegNo)
Definition xlog.c:8084
static void XLogWrite(XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst, TimeLineID tli, bool flexible)
Definition xlog.c:2308
void InitializeWalConsistencyChecking(void)
Definition xlog.c:4859
static void UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(XLogRecPtr lsn, bool force)
Definition xlog.c:2704
static int LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed(void)
Definition xlog.c:6549
void assign_max_wal_size(int newval, void *extra)
Definition xlog.c:2204
void RemoveNonParentXlogFiles(XLogRecPtr switchpoint, TimeLineID newTLI)
Definition xlog.c:3978
XLogRecPtr GetLastImportantRecPtr(void)
Definition xlog.c:6683
void xlog_redo(XLogReaderState *record)
Definition xlog.c:8368
static int MyLockNo
Definition xlog.c:653
static void RecoveryRestartPoint(const CheckPoint *checkPoint, XLogReaderState *record)
Definition xlog.c:7682
bool XLogNeedsFlush(XLogRecPtr record)
Definition xlog.c:3146
void register_persistent_abort_backup_handler(void)
Definition xlog.c:9582
static double PrevCheckPointDistance
Definition xlog.c:163
void ReachedEndOfBackup(XLogRecPtr EndRecPtr, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:6374
void LocalProcessControlFile(bool reset)
Definition xlog.c:4940
static void XLogFileClose(void)
Definition xlog.c:3677
int wal_compression
Definition xlog.c:127
static void UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate(uint64 nbytes)
Definition xlog.c:6913
static bool LocalRecoveryInProgress
Definition xlog.c:227
XLogSegNo XLogGetOldestSegno(TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:3812
XLogRecPtr GetXLogWriteRecPtr(void)
Definition xlog.c:9612
void ResetInstallXLogFileSegmentActive(void)
Definition xlog.c:9653
static WALInsertLockPadded * WALInsertLocks
Definition xlog.c:571
static XLogSegNo openLogSegNo
Definition xlog.c:638
#define INSERT_FREESPACE(endptr)
Definition xlog.c:582
int wal_retrieve_retry_interval
Definition xlog.c:137
int XLOGbuffers
Definition xlog.c:120
bool XLogBackgroundFlush(void)
Definition xlog.c:2989
const struct config_enum_entry archive_mode_options[]
Definition xlog.c:194
void GetOldestRestartPoint(XLogRecPtr *oldrecptr, TimeLineID *oldtli)
Definition xlog.c:9624
char * GetMockAuthenticationNonce(void)
Definition xlog.c:4638
bool track_wal_io_timing
Definition xlog.c:140
static XLogSegNo XLOGfileslop(XLogRecPtr lastredoptr)
Definition xlog.c:2234
static int UsableBytesInSegment
Definition xlog.c:608
static char * GetXLogBuffer(XLogRecPtr ptr, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:1639
WalInsertClass
Definition xlog.c:562
@ WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH
Definition xlog.c:564
@ WALINSERT_NORMAL
Definition xlog.c:563
@ WALINSERT_SPECIAL_CHECKPOINT
Definition xlog.c:565
bool XLogInsertAllowed(void)
Definition xlog.c:6516
void do_pg_backup_start(const char *backupidstr, bool fast, List **tablespaces, BackupState *state, StringInfo tblspcmapfile)
Definition xlog.c:8953
static ControlFileData * ControlFile
Definition xlog.c:576
bool check_wal_segment_size(int *newval, void **extra, GucSource source)
Definition xlog.c:2218
static void XLogFileCopy(TimeLineID destTLI, XLogSegNo destsegno, TimeLineID srcTLI, XLogSegNo srcsegno, int upto)
Definition xlog.c:3456
static int LocalXLogInsertAllowed
Definition xlog.c:239
static void RemoveTempXlogFiles(void)
Definition xlog.c:3870
XLogRecPtr XLogRestorePoint(const char *rpName)
Definition xlog.c:8211
static XLogRecPtr LocalMinRecoveryPoint
Definition xlog.c:648
#define NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS
Definition xlog.c:153
TimeLineID GetWALInsertionTimeLineIfSet(void)
Definition xlog.c:6663
void do_pg_backup_stop(BackupState *state, bool waitforarchive)
Definition xlog.c:9281
bool check_wal_consistency_checking(char **newval, void **extra, GucSource source)
Definition xlog.c:4745
const struct config_enum_entry wal_sync_method_options[]
Definition xlog.c:174
int min_wal_size_mb
Definition xlog.c:118
bool CreateCheckPoint(int flags)
Definition xlog.c:7016
#define BootstrapTimeLineID
Definition xlog.c:114
CheckpointStatsData CheckpointStats
Definition xlog.c:212
bool check_wal_buffers(int *newval, void **extra, GucSource source)
Definition xlog.c:4710
XLogRecPtr GetFakeLSNForUnloggedRel(void)
Definition xlog.c:4677
static char * str_time(pg_time_t tnow, char *buf, size_t bufsize)
Definition xlog.c:5290
void XLogPutNextOid(Oid nextOid)
Definition xlog.c:8156
void XLogFlush(XLogRecPtr record)
Definition xlog.c:2784
static void ReadControlFile(void)
Definition xlog.c:4387
static SessionBackupState sessionBackupState
Definition xlog.c:394
static void CheckPointGuts(XLogRecPtr checkPointRedo, int flags)
Definition xlog.c:7642
static bool updateMinRecoveryPoint
Definition xlog.c:650
int CheckPointSegments
Definition xlog.c:159
static bool check_wal_consistency_checking_deferred
Definition xlog.c:169
static void ReserveXLogInsertLocation(int size, XLogRecPtr *StartPos, XLogRecPtr *EndPos, XLogRecPtr *PrevPtr)
Definition xlog.c:1115
void XLogShutdownWalRcv(void)
Definition xlog.c:9634
#define NextBufIdx(idx)
Definition xlog.c:586
static void UpdateLastRemovedPtr(char *filename)
Definition xlog.c:3850
static TimeLineID LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI
Definition xlog.c:649
void issue_xlog_fsync(int fd, XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:8856
static bool ReserveXLogSwitch(XLogRecPtr *StartPos, XLogRecPtr *EndPos, XLogRecPtr *PrevPtr)
Definition xlog.c:1171
void XLogSetAsyncXactLSN(XLogRecPtr asyncXactLSN)
Definition xlog.c:2613
bool XLogCheckpointNeeded(XLogSegNo new_segno)
Definition xlog.c:2284
bool * wal_consistency_checking
Definition xlog.c:129
static int XLogFileInitInternal(XLogSegNo logsegno, TimeLineID logtli, bool *added, char *path)
Definition xlog.c:3230
static void update_checkpoint_display(int flags, bool restartpoint, bool reset)
Definition xlog.c:6951
#define XLogArchivingActive()
Definition xlog.h:101
#define TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD
Definition xlog.h:322
#define XLOG_MARK_UNIMPORTANT
Definition xlog.h:166
#define TABLESPACE_MAP
Definition xlog.h:321
@ ARCHIVE_MODE_ALWAYS
Definition xlog.h:68
@ ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF
Definition xlog.h:66
@ ARCHIVE_MODE_ON
Definition xlog.h:67
#define CHECKPOINT_FLUSH_UNLOGGED
Definition xlog.h:154
#define XLogLogicalInfoActive()
Definition xlog.h:136
#define STANDBY_SIGNAL_FILE
Definition xlog.h:317
#define CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_XLOG
Definition xlog.h:159
WALAvailability
Definition xlog.h:199
@ WALAVAIL_REMOVED
Definition xlog.h:205
@ WALAVAIL_RESERVED
Definition xlog.h:201
@ WALAVAIL_UNRESERVED
Definition xlog.h:204
@ WALAVAIL_EXTENDED
Definition xlog.h:202
@ WALAVAIL_INVALID_LSN
Definition xlog.h:200
#define BACKUP_LABEL_OLD
Definition xlog.h:319
#define CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY
Definition xlog.h:151
@ WAL_COMPRESSION_NONE
Definition xlog.h:83
#define BACKUP_LABEL_FILE
Definition xlog.h:318
#define CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_TIME
Definition xlog.h:160
#define CHECKPOINT_FORCE
Definition xlog.h:153
SessionBackupState
Definition xlog.h:302
@ SESSION_BACKUP_RUNNING
Definition xlog.h:304
@ SESSION_BACKUP_NONE
Definition xlog.h:303
#define CHECKPOINT_WAIT
Definition xlog.h:156
#define CHECKPOINT_FAST
Definition xlog.h:152
#define RECOVERY_SIGNAL_FILE
Definition xlog.h:316
#define CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN
Definition xlog.h:150
#define XLogArchivingAlways()
Definition xlog.h:104
WalLevel
Definition xlog.h:74
@ WAL_LEVEL_REPLICA
Definition xlog.h:76
@ WAL_LEVEL_LOGICAL
Definition xlog.h:77
@ WAL_LEVEL_MINIMAL
Definition xlog.h:75
RecoveryState
Definition xlog.h:91
@ RECOVERY_STATE_CRASH
Definition xlog.h:92
@ RECOVERY_STATE_DONE
Definition xlog.h:94
@ RECOVERY_STATE_ARCHIVE
Definition xlog.h:93
#define XLogIsNeeded()
Definition xlog.h:111
@ WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN
Definition xlog.h:27
@ WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FDATASYNC
Definition xlog.h:26
@ WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH
Definition xlog.h:28
@ WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC
Definition xlog.h:29
@ WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC
Definition xlog.h:25
#define XLogStandbyInfoActive()
Definition xlog.h:125
#define XLP_FIRST_IS_CONTRECORD
static RmgrData GetRmgr(RmgrId rmid)
#define IsValidWalSegSize(size)
XLogLongPageHeaderData * XLogLongPageHeader
#define XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD
#define XLOG_CONTROL_FILE
#define XLogSegmentOffset(xlogptr, wal_segsz_bytes)
static bool IsXLogFileName(const char *fname)
static void XLogFromFileName(const char *fname, TimeLineID *tli, XLogSegNo *logSegNo, int wal_segsz_bytes)
#define XLByteToPrevSeg(xlrp, logSegNo, wal_segsz_bytes)
#define XLogSegNoOffsetToRecPtr(segno, offset, wal_segsz_bytes, dest)
#define MAXFNAMELEN
XLogPageHeaderData * XLogPageHeader
#define XLOGDIR
#define XLP_LONG_HEADER
static bool IsBackupHistoryFileName(const char *fname)
#define XLP_BKP_REMOVABLE
#define XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC
#define XLByteToSeg(xlrp, logSegNo, wal_segsz_bytes)
static void BackupHistoryFileName(char *fname, TimeLineID tli, XLogSegNo logSegNo, XLogRecPtr startpoint, int wal_segsz_bytes)
static void XLogFilePath(char *path, TimeLineID tli, XLogSegNo logSegNo, int wal_segsz_bytes)
#define XRecOffIsValid(xlrp)
#define SizeOfXLogShortPHD
#define SizeOfXLogLongPHD
static void XLogFileName(char *fname, TimeLineID tli, XLogSegNo logSegNo, int wal_segsz_bytes)
static void BackupHistoryFilePath(char *path, TimeLineID tli, XLogSegNo logSegNo, XLogRecPtr startpoint, int wal_segsz_bytes)
static bool RmgrIdExists(RmgrId rmid)
#define XLByteInPrevSeg(xlrp, logSegNo, wal_segsz_bytes)
static bool IsPartialXLogFileName(const char *fname)
bool XLogArchiveIsReadyOrDone(const char *xlog)
bool XLogArchiveIsBusy(const char *xlog)
bool XLogArchiveIsReady(const char *xlog)
void XLogArchiveNotifySeg(XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli)
void ExecuteRecoveryCommand(const char *command, const char *commandName, bool failOnSignal, uint32 wait_event_info)
bool XLogArchiveCheckDone(const char *xlog)
void XLogArchiveNotify(const char *xlog)
void XLogArchiveCleanup(const char *xlog)
char * build_backup_content(BackupState *state, bool ishistoryfile)
Definition xlogbackup.c:29
#define XLogRecPtrIsValid(r)
Definition xlogdefs.h:29
#define LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(lsn)
Definition xlogdefs.h:47
#define FirstNormalUnloggedLSN
Definition xlogdefs.h:37
uint64 XLogRecPtr
Definition xlogdefs.h:21
#define InvalidXLogRecPtr
Definition xlogdefs.h:28
uint32 TimeLineID
Definition xlogdefs.h:63
#define DEFAULT_WAL_SYNC_METHOD
Definition xlogdefs.h:83
uint64 XLogSegNo
Definition xlogdefs.h:52
XLogRecPtr XLogInsert(RmgrId rmid, uint8 info)
Definition xloginsert.c:478
void XLogRegisterData(const void *data, uint32 len)
Definition xloginsert.c:368
void XLogSetRecordFlags(uint8 flags)
Definition xloginsert.c:460
void XLogBeginInsert(void)
Definition xloginsert.c:152
XLogReaderState * XLogReaderAllocate(int wal_segment_size, const char *waldir, XLogReaderRoutine *routine, void *private_data)
Definition xlogreader.c:107
bool DecodeXLogRecord(XLogReaderState *state, DecodedXLogRecord *decoded, XLogRecord *record, XLogRecPtr lsn, char **errormsg)
size_t DecodeXLogRecordRequiredSpace(size_t xl_tot_len)
#define XLogRecGetInfo(decoder)
Definition xlogreader.h:409
#define XLogRecGetData(decoder)
Definition xlogreader.h:414
#define XL_ROUTINE(...)
Definition xlogreader.h:117
#define XLogRecMaxBlockId(decoder)
Definition xlogreader.h:417
#define XLogRecHasBlockImage(decoder, block_id)
Definition xlogreader.h:422
#define XLogRecHasAnyBlockRefs(decoder)
Definition xlogreader.h:416
#define SizeOfXLogRecordDataHeaderShort
Definition xlogrecord.h:217
#define XLR_BLOCK_ID_DATA_SHORT
Definition xlogrecord.h:241
#define SizeOfXLogRecord
Definition xlogrecord.h:55
void ShutdownWalRecovery(void)
bool ArchiveRecoveryRequested
bool InArchiveRecovery
void RecoveryRequiresIntParameter(const char *param_name, int currValue, int minValue)
void PerformWalRecovery(void)
char * archiveCleanupCommand
XLogRecPtr GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(TimeLineID *replayEndTLI)
void xlog_outdesc(StringInfo buf, XLogReaderState *record)
bool PromoteIsTriggered(void)
static XLogRecPtr missingContrecPtr
XLogRecPtr GetXLogReplayRecPtr(TimeLineID *replayTLI)
static XLogRecPtr abortedRecPtr
EndOfWalRecoveryInfo * FinishWalRecovery(void)
void InitWalRecovery(ControlFileData *ControlFile, bool *wasShutdown_ptr, bool *haveBackupLabel_ptr, bool *haveTblspcMap_ptr)
char * recoveryEndCommand
TimeLineID recoveryTargetTLI
TimestampTz GetLatestXTime(void)
bool XLogHaveInvalidPages(void)
Definition xlogutils.c:224
XLogRedoAction XLogReadBufferForRedo(XLogReaderState *record, uint8 block_id, Buffer *buf)
Definition xlogutils.c:303
HotStandbyState standbyState
Definition xlogutils.c:53
bool InRecovery
Definition xlogutils.c:50
@ STANDBY_DISABLED
Definition xlogutils.h:52
@ STANDBY_INITIALIZED
Definition xlogutils.h:53
#define InHotStandby
Definition xlogutils.h:60
@ BLK_RESTORED
Definition xlogutils.h:76
struct WaitLSNState * waitLSNState
Definition xlogwait.c:68
void WaitLSNWakeup(WaitLSNType lsnType, XLogRecPtr currentLSN)
Definition xlogwait.c:317
@ WAIT_LSN_TYPE_PRIMARY_FLUSH
Definition xlogwait.h:44
@ WAIT_LSN_TYPE_STANDBY_REPLAY
Definition xlogwait.h:39
@ WAIT_LSN_TYPE_STANDBY_FLUSH
Definition xlogwait.h:41
@ WAIT_LSN_TYPE_STANDBY_WRITE
Definition xlogwait.h:40